blob: 0585b89adc51f1380dd1b4e43a17d707f3fb0842 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau60612eb2011-09-10 23:43:11 +02007 2011/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200451 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100452 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200453 - noepoll
454 - nokqueue
455 - nopoll
456 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100457 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200458 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200459 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200460 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200461 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100462 - tune.maxaccept
463 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200464 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200465 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100466 - tune.rcvbuf.client
467 - tune.rcvbuf.server
468 - tune.sndbuf.client
469 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471 * Debugging
472 - debug
473 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474
475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477------------------------------------
478
479chroot <jail dir>
480 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
481 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
482 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
483 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
484 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
485 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487daemon
488 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
489 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
490 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
491
492gid <number>
493 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
494 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
495 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
496 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498group <group name>
499 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
500 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200502log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
504 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100505 configured with "log global".
506
507 <address> can be one of:
508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100509 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100510 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
511 port).
512
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100513 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
514 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
515 port).
516
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100517 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
518 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
519 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
520 writeable).
521
522 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523
524 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
525 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
526 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
527
528 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200529 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
530 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
531 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
532 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
533 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
534 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200535
536 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
537
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100538log-send-hostname [<string>]
539 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
540 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
541 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
542 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
543 the logs.
544
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000545log-tag <string>
546 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
547 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
548 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
549 running on the same host.
550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551nbproc <number>
552 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
553 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
554 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
555 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
556 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
557
558pidfile <pidfile>
559 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
560 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
561 starting the process. See also "daemon".
562
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200563stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200564 [level <level>]
565
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200566 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
567 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100568 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200569 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
570
571 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
572 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
573 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
574 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
575 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
576
577 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200578 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200579 counters).
580
581 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
582 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100583
584 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
585 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
586 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
587 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
588 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
589 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
590 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200591
592stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
593 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
594 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100595 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200596
597stats maxconn <connections>
598 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
599 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601uid <number>
602 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
603 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
604 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
605 one. See also "gid" and "user".
606
607ulimit-n <number>
608 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
609 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
610 option.
611
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100612unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
613 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
614
615 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
616 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
617 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
618 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
619 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
620 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
621 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
622 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
623 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
624 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626user <user name>
627 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
628 See also "uid" and "group".
629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200630node <name>
631 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
632
633 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
634 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
635 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
636 traffic.
637
638description <text>
639 Add a text that describes the instance.
640
641 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
642 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
643 "<" and ">" characters.
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006463.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647-----------------------
648
649maxconn <number>
650 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
651 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
652 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
653 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
654
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200655maxconnrate <number>
656 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
663 fairness.
664
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100665maxpipes <number>
666 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
667 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
668 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
669 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
670 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
671 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673noepoll
674 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
675 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
676 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
677
678nokqueue
679 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
680 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
681 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
682
683nopoll
684 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
685 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100686 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200687 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
688 "nokqueue".
689
690nosepoll
691 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
692 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
693 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
694
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100695nosplice
696 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
697 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
698 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100699 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100700 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
701 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
702 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
703 "option splice-response".
704
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200705spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
706 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
707 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
708 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
709 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
710 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
711
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200712tune.bufsize <number>
713 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
714 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
715 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
716 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
717 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
718 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
719 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
720 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
721
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200722tune.chksize <number>
723 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
724 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
725 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
726 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
727 checks whenever possible.
728
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200729tune.http.maxhdr <number>
730 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
731 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
732 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
733 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
734 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
735 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
736 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
737 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
738 limit too high.
739
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100740tune.maxaccept <number>
741 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
742 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
743 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100744 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100745 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
746 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100747 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100748 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
749
750tune.maxpollevents <number>
751 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
752 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
753 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
754 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
755 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
756
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200757tune.maxrewrite <number>
758 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
759 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
760 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
761 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
762 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
763 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
764 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
765 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
766 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
767 bufsize.
768
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200769tune.pipesize <number>
770 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
771 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
772 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
773 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
774 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
775 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
776
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100777tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
778tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
779 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
780 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
781 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
782 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
783 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
784 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
785 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
786
787tune.sndbuf.client <number>
788tune.sndbuf.server <number>
789 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
790 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
791 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
792 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
793 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
794 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
795 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
796 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
797 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
798 notifying haproxy again.
799
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008013.3. Debugging
802--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803
804debug
805 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
806 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
807 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
808 system startup.
809
810quiet
811 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
812 line argument "-q".
813
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008153.4. Userlists
816--------------
817It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
818http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
819it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
820
821userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100822 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100823 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
824
825group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100826 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100827 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
828 proceeded by "users" keyword.
829
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100830user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
831 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100832 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
833 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100834 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
835 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100836 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
837 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
838
839
840 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100841 userlist L1
842 group G1 users tiger,scott
843 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100844
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100845 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
846 user scott insecure-password elgato
847 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100848
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100849 userlist L2
850 group G1
851 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100852
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100853 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
854 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
855 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100856
857 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200858
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200859
8603.5. Peers
861--------------
862It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
863haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
864pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
865identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
866or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
867Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
868known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
869the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
870process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
871during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
872tables.
873
874peers <peersect>
875 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
876 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
877
878peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
879 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
880 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
881 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
882 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
883 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
884 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
885
886 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
887 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
888
889 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
890 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
891 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
892 across all peers.
893
894Example:
895 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100896 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
897 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
898 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200899
900 backend mybackend
901 mode tcp
902 balance roundrobin
903 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
904 stick on src
905
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100906 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
907 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200908
909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009104. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200911----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100912
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
914 - defaults <name>
915 - frontend <name>
916 - backend <name>
917 - listen <name>
918
919A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
920its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
921section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100922section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
924A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
925connections.
926
927A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
928to forward incoming connections.
929
930A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
931parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100933All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
934'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
935case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
936
937Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
938logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
939proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
940However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
941name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
942
943Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
944and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100945bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100946protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
947modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
948arbitrary criteria.
949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009514.1. Proxy keywords matrix
952--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200954The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
955limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
956they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
957limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100958marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200959option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200960and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
961with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
962specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100963
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200964
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100965 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
966------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
967acl - X X X
968appsession - - X X
969backlog X X X -
970balance X - X X
971bind - X X -
972bind-process X X X X
973block - X X X
974capture cookie - X X -
975capture request header - X X -
976capture response header - X X -
977clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
978contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
979cookie X - X X
980default-server X - X X
981default_backend X X X -
982description - X X X
983disabled X X X X
984dispatch - - X X
985enabled X X X X
986errorfile X X X X
987errorloc X X X X
988errorloc302 X X X X
989-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
990errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200991force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100992fullconn X - X X
993grace X X X X
994hash-type X - X X
995http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100996http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200997http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100998http-request - X X X
999id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001000ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001001log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001002maxconn X X X -
1003mode X X X X
1004monitor fail - X X -
1005monitor-net X X X -
1006monitor-uri X X X -
1007option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1008option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1009option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1010option allbackups (*) X - X X
1011option checkcache (*) X - X X
1012option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1013option contstats (*) X X X -
1014option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1015option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1016option forceclose (*) X X X X
1017-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1018option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001019option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001020option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001021option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1022option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1023option httpchk X - X X
1024option httpclose (*) X X X X
1025option httplog X X X X
1026option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1027option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001028option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001029option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1030option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1031option logasap (*) X X X -
1032option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001033option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001034option nolinger (*) X X X X
1035option originalto X X X X
1036option persist (*) X - X X
1037option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001038option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001039option smtpchk X - X X
1040option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1041option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1042option splice-request (*) X X X X
1043option splice-response (*) X X X X
1044option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1045option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1046-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1047option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1048option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1049option tcpka X X X X
1050option tcplog X X X X
1051option transparent (*) X - X X
1052persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1053rate-limit sessions X X X -
1054redirect - X X X
1055redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1056redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1057reqadd - X X X
1058reqallow - X X X
1059reqdel - X X X
1060reqdeny - X X X
1061reqiallow - X X X
1062reqidel - X X X
1063reqideny - X X X
1064reqipass - X X X
1065reqirep - X X X
1066reqisetbe - X X X
1067reqitarpit - X X X
1068reqpass - X X X
1069reqrep - X X X
1070-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1071reqsetbe - X X X
1072reqtarpit - X X X
1073retries X - X X
1074rspadd - X X X
1075rspdel - X X X
1076rspdeny - X X X
1077rspidel - X X X
1078rspideny - X X X
1079rspirep - X X X
1080rsprep - X X X
1081server - - X X
1082source X - X X
1083srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001084stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001085stats auth X - X X
1086stats enable X - X X
1087stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001088stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001089stats realm X - X X
1090stats refresh X - X X
1091stats scope X - X X
1092stats show-desc X - X X
1093stats show-legends X - X X
1094stats show-node X - X X
1095stats uri X - X X
1096-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1097stick match - - X X
1098stick on - - X X
1099stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001100stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001101stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001102tcp-request connection - X X -
1103tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001104tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001105tcp-response content - - X X
1106tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001107timeout check X - X X
1108timeout client X X X -
1109timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1110timeout connect X - X X
1111timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1112timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1113timeout http-request X X X X
1114timeout queue X - X X
1115timeout server X - X X
1116timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1117timeout tarpit X X X X
1118transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1119use_backend - X X -
1120------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1121 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011244.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1125---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001126
1127This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1128
1129
1130acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1131 Declare or complete an access list.
1132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1133 no | yes | yes | yes
1134 Example:
1135 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1136 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1137 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001139 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140
1141
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001142appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1143 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001144 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1146 no | no | yes | yes
1147 Arguments :
1148 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1149 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1150
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001151 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001152 checked in each cookie value.
1153
1154 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1155 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1156 milliseconds.
1157
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001158 request-learn
1159 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1160 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1161 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1162 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1163 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1164 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1165
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001166 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1167 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1168 data following this prefix.
1169
1170 Example :
1171 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1172
1173 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1174 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1175
1176 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1177 2 modes are currently supported :
1178 - path-parameters :
1179 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1180 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1181 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1182 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1183 - query-string :
1184 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1185 query string.
1186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001187 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1188 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1189 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1190 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001191 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1192 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1193 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001194 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1195 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1196
1197 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1198
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001199 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1200 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1201 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 Example :
1204 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1205
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001206 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1207 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001208
1209
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001210backlog <conns>
1211 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1213 yes | yes | yes | no
1214 Arguments :
1215 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1216 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1217 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1218
1219 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1220 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1221 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1222 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1223 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1224 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1225 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1226 backlog parameter.
1227
1228 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1229 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1230 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1231
1232 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1233
1234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001235balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001236balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001237 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1239 yes | no | yes | yes
1240 Arguments :
1241 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1242 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1243 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1244 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1245
1246 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1247 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1248 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1249 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001250 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1251 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1252 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1253 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1254 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1255 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1256 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1257 it, so that you don't worry.
1258
1259 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1260 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1261 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1262 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1263 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1264 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1265 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1266 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001267
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001268 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1269 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1270 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1271 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1272 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1273 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1274 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1275 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1276
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001277 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1278 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1279 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1280 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1281 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1282 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1283 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1284 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001285 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001286 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001287 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1288 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1289 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001290
1291 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1292 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1293 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1294 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1295 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1296 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1297 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001298 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1299 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1300 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001301
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001302 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1303 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1304 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1305 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1306 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1307 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1308 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1309 URIs start with a leading "/".
1310
1311 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1312 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1313 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1314 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001316 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001317 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1318
1319 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1320 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001321 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1322 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001323 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1324 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1325 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1326 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1327 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1328 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1329 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1330 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1331 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1332 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1333 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1334 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1335 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1336 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1337 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1338 be randomly balanced if at all.
1339
1340 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1341 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1342 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1343 server will receive the request.
1344
1345 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1346 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1347 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1348 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1349 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001350 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1351 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1352 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001353
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001354 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001355 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1356 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001357 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001358 algorithm is applied instead.
1359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001360 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001361 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1362 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1363 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1364
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001365 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1366 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1367 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1368
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001369 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001370 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001371 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1372 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1373 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1374 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1375 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1376 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001377 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001378 used instead.
1379
1380 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1381 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1382 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1383 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1384
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001385 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1386 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1387 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1388
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001389 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001391 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001392 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1393 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001394
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001395 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001396 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001397
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001398 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1399 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1400 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001401
1402 Examples :
1403 balance roundrobin
1404 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001405 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001406 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1407 balance hdr(host)
1408 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001409
1410 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1411 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001413 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001414 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1415 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1416 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1417 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1418
1419 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1420 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1421 defaults to 16 kB.
1422
1423 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1424 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1425
1426 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1427 Round Robin.
1428
1429 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1430 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1431 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1432 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1433
1434 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1435
1436 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001437 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001438 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1439 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1440 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001442 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1443 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001444
1445
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001446bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1447bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1448bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1449bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1450bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1451bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1452bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001453bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001454bind /<path> [, ...]
1455bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1456bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1457bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1460 no | yes | yes | no
1461 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001462 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1463 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1464 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1465 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001466 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001467
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001468 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1469 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001470 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1471 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1472 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001473 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1474 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1475 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1476 the range.
1477
1478 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1479 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1480 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1481 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1482 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1483 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1484 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1485 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1486 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001488 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1489 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1490 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1491 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1492 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1493 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1494 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1495 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1496
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001497 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1498 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1499 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1500 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1501 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1502 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1503 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1504 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001505 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1506 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001507
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001508 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1509 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1510 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1511 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1512 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1513 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001514 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1515 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1516 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1517 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1518 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1519 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1520 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1521 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001522
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001523 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1524 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1525 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1526 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001527
1528 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1529
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001530 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1531 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1532 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1533 simply ignore this.
1534
1535 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1536 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1537 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1538 simply ignore this.
1539
1540 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1541 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1542 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1543 this.
1544
1545 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1546 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1547 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1548 this.
1549
1550 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1551 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1552 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1553 this.
1554
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001555 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1556 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1557 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001558 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001559 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1560 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1561 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1562 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001563 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1564 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001566 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001567 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1568 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1569 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1570 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1571 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1572 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1573 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1574 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1575 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1576 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1577 with front firewalls which would see an established
1578 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1579
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001580 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1581 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1582 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1583 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1584 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1585 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1586 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1587 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1588 This keyword combined with support from external components
1589 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1590 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1591 not even always usable.
1592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001593 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1594 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1595 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1596 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1597 in a frontend.
1598
1599 Example :
1600 listen http_proxy
1601 bind :80,:443
1602 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001603 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001605 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001606 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607
1608
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001609bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1610 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1612 yes | yes | yes | yes
1613 Arguments :
1614 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1615 may be used to override a default value.
1616
1617 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1618 option may be combined with other numbers.
1619
1620 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1621 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1622 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1623 missing from all processes.
1624
1625 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1626 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1627 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1628 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1629
1630 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1631 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1632 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1633 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1634 and 'even' instances.
1635
1636 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1637 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1638 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1639 32.
1640
1641 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1642 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1643
1644 Example :
1645 listen app_ip1
1646 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001647 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001648
1649 listen app_ip2
1650 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001651 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001652
1653 listen management
1654 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001655 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001656
1657 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1658
1659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001660block { if | unless } <condition>
1661 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1663 no | yes | yes | yes
1664
1665 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1666 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001667 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001668 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001669 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1670 "block" statements per instance.
1671
1672 Example:
1673 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1674 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1675 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1676 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001678 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679
1680
1681capture cookie <name> len <length>
1682 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1684 no | yes | yes | no
1685 Arguments :
1686 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1687 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1688 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1689 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1690 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1691
1692 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1693 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1694 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1695 right if it exceeds <length>.
1696
1697 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1698 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1699 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1700 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1701
1702 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1703 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1704 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1705
1706 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1707 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1708 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1709 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001710 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001711 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1712
1713 Example:
1714 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1715
1716 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001717 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718
1719
1720capture request header <name> len <length>
1721 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1723 no | yes | yes | no
1724 Arguments :
1725 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001726 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001727 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1728 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1729 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1730
1731 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1732 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1733 it exceeds <length>.
1734
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001735 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1737 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001738 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1739 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1740 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1741 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001742 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001743 environments to find where the request came from.
1744
1745 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1746 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1747 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1748 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749
1750 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1751 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1752 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1753 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1754
1755 Example:
1756 capture request header Host len 15
1757 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1758 capture request header Referrer len 15
1759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001760 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761 about logging.
1762
1763
1764capture response header <name> len <length>
1765 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1767 no | yes | yes | no
1768 Arguments :
1769 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001770 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1772 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1773 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1774
1775 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1776 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1777 it exceeds <length>.
1778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001779 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1781 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1782 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001783 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1784 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1785 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1786 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787
1788 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1789 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1790 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1791 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1792
1793 Example:
1794 capture response header Content-length len 9
1795 capture response header Location len 15
1796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001797 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798 about logging.
1799
1800
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001801clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1804 yes | yes | yes | no
1805 Arguments :
1806 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1808 as explained at the top of this document.
1809
1810 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1811 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1812 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1813 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1814 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1815 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1816 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1817 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001818 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1820 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1821
1822 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1823 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1824 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1825 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1826 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1827 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1828
1829 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1830 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1831
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001832 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1833 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001834
1835
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001836contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1839 yes | no | yes | yes
1840 Arguments :
1841 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1843 as explained at the top of this document.
1844
1845 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001846 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001847 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1849 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1850 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1851 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1852
1853 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1854 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1855 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1856 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1857 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1858 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1859
1860 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1861 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1862 instead.
1863
1864 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1865 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1866
1867
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001868cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001869 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001870 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1873 yes | no | yes | yes
1874 Arguments :
1875 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1876 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1877 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1878 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1879 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1880 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1881 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1882 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1883 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1884
1885 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1886 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1887 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1888 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1889 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1890 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1891 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1892 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1893 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1894 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1895 "insert" and "prefix".
1896
1897 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001898 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001899
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001900 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001901 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1902 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1903 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1904 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1905 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1906 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1907 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1908 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1909 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1910 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911
1912 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1913 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1914 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1915 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1916 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1917 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1918 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1919 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1920 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1921 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001922 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1923 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1924 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001926 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1927 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1928 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001929 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1930 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1931 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1932 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001933 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1934 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1935 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936
1937 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1938 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1939 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1940 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1941 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1942 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1943 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1944 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1945 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1946
1947 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1948 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1949 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1950 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1951 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1952 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1953 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1954 persistence cookie in the cache.
1955 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1956
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001957 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1958 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1959 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1960 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1961 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1962 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1963 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1964 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1965 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1966 they logout.
1967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001968 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001969 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001970 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1971 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1972 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1973 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1974 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1975 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001976
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001977 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1978 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1979 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1980 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1981 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1982 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1983 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1984 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1985 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1986 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1987 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1988 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1989 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1990 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1991 the site.
1992
1993 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1994 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1995 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1996 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1997 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1998 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1999 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2000 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2001 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2002 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2003 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2004 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2005 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2006 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2007 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2008 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2009
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2011 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2012 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2013 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015 Examples :
2016 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2017 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2018 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002019 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002021 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002022 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002025default-server [param*]
2026 Change default options for a server in a backend
2027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2028 yes | no | yes | yes
2029 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002030 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2031 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2032 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2033 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002034
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002035 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002036 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2037
2038 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041default_backend <backend>
2042 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | yes | yes | no
2045 Arguments :
2046 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2047
2048 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2049 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2050 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2051 will catch all undetermined requests.
2052
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053 Example :
2054
2055 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2056 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2057 default_backend dynamic
2058
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002059 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061
2062disabled
2063 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | yes | yes | yes
2066 Arguments : none
2067
2068 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2069 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2070 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2071 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2072 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2073 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2074 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2075
2076 See also : "enabled"
2077
2078
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002079dispatch <address>:<port>
2080 Set a default server address
2081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2082 no | no | yes | yes
2083 Arguments : none
2084
2085 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2086 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2087 during start-up.
2088
2089 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2090 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2091 possible with normal servers.
2092
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002093 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002094 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2095 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2096 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2097 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2098
2099 See also : "server"
2100
2101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102enabled
2103 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2105 yes | yes | yes | yes
2106 Arguments : none
2107
2108 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2109 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2110
2111 See also : "disabled"
2112
2113
2114errorfile <code> <file>
2115 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2117 yes | yes | yes | yes
2118 Arguments :
2119 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002120 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121
2122 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002123 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002125 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2126 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
2128 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2129 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2130 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2131
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002132 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2135 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2136 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2137 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2138
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002139 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2140 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2141 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2142 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2143 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2144 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2147 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2148 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002149 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2151
2152 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2153
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002154 Example :
2155 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2156 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2157 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2158
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002159
2160errorloc <code> <url>
2161errorloc302 <code> <url>
2162 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2164 yes | yes | yes | yes
2165 Arguments :
2166 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002167 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002168
2169 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2170 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2171 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2172 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2173 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2174
2175 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2176 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2177 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2178
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002179 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2180
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002181 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2182 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2183 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2184 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2185 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2186 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2187 request.
2188
2189 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2190
2191
2192errorloc303 <code> <url>
2193 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2195 yes | yes | yes | yes
2196 Arguments :
2197 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2198 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2199
2200 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2201 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2202 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2203 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2204 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2205
2206 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2207 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2208 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2209
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002210 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2211
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002212 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2213 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2214 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2215 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002216 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002217
2218 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2219
2220
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002221force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2222 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2223 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2224 no | yes | yes | yes
2225
2226 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2227 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2228 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2229 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2230 marked down for maintenance operations.
2231
2232 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2233 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2234 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2235 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2236 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2237 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2238 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2239 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2240 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2241
2242 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2243 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2244 is used.
2245
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002246 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002247 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002248
2249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002250fullconn <conns>
2251 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2253 yes | no | yes | yes
2254 Arguments :
2255 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2256 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2257
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002258 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002259 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002260 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002261 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2262 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2263 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2264 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2265 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002266 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002267
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002268 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2269 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2270 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2271
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002272 Example :
2273 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2274 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2275 # connections.
2276 backend dynamic
2277 fullconn 10000
2278 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2279 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2280
2281 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2282
2283
2284grace <time>
2285 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002287 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002288 Arguments :
2289 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2290 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2291 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2292
2293 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2294 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002295 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002296 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2297
2298 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2299 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2300 simplify it.
2301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002303hash-type <method>
2304 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2306 yes | no | yes | yes
2307 Arguments :
2308 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2309 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2310 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2311 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2312 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2313 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2314 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2315 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2316 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2317
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002318 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2319 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2320 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2321 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2322 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2323 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2324 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2325 this value.
2326
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002327 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2328 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2329 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2330 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2331 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2332 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2333 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2334 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2335 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2336 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2337 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2338 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2339 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2340
2341 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2342
2343 See also : "balance", "server"
2344
2345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346http-check disable-on-404
2347 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002349 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002350 Arguments : none
2351
2352 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2353 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2354 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2355 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2356 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2357 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2358 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2359 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002360 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2361 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2362 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2363
2364 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2365
2366
2367http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2368 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002371 Arguments :
2372 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2373 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2374 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2375 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2376 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2377 details on the supported keywords.
2378
2379 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2380 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2381 with the usual backslash ('\').
2382
2383 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2384 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2385 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2386 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2387 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2388
2389 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2390 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2391 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2392 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2393 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2394
2395 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2396 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2397 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2398 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2399 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2400 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2401
2402 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2403 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2404 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2405 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2406 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2407 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2408 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2409 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2410 trace).
2411
2412 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2413 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2414 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2415 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2416 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2417 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2418 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2419 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2420
2421 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2422 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2423 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2424 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2425 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2426 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2427 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2428 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2429
2430 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2431 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2432
2433 Examples :
2434 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002435 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002436
2437 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002438 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002439
2440 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002441 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002442
2443 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002444 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002446 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002447
2448
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002449http-check send-state
2450 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | no | yes | yes
2453 Arguments : none
2454
2455 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2456 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2457 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2458 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2459 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2460
2461 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2462 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2463 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2464 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2465 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2466 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2467 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2468 checked in multiple backends.
2469
2470 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2471 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2472
2473 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2474 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2475 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2476 one fails.
2477
2478 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2479 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2480 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2481
2482 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2483 server's queue.
2484
2485 Example of a header received by the application server :
2486 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2487 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2488
2489 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2490
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002491http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002492 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002493 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2494
2495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 no | yes | yes | yes
2497
2498 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2499 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2500 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002501 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2502 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002503 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2504
2505 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2506 instance.
2507
2508 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002509 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2510 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2511 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002512
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002513 http-request allow if nagios
2514 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2515 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2516 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002517
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002518 Example:
2519 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002520
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002521 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002522
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002523 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2524 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002525
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002526http-send-name-header [<header>]
2527 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2528
2529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 yes | no | yes | yes
2531
2532 Arguments :
2533
2534 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2535
2536 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2537 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2538 is added with the header string proved.
2539
2540 See also : "server"
2541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002542id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002543 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2545 no | yes | yes | yes
2546 Arguments : none
2547
2548 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2549 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2550 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002551
2552
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002553ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2554 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2556 no | yes | yes | yes
2557
2558 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2559 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2560 and running).
2561
2562 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2563 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2564 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2565 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2566 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2567
2568 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2569 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2570
2571 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2572 "unless" condition is met.
2573
2574 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2575
2576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002578log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002579no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002580 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002583
2584 Prefix :
2585 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2586 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2587 prefix does not allow arguments.
2588
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002589 Arguments :
2590 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2591 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2592 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2593 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2594 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2595 parameter.
2596
2597 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2598 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2599
2600 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2601 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2602 standard syslog port).
2603
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002604 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2605 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2606 standard syslog port).
2607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002608 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2609 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2610 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2611 appropriately writeable).
2612
2613 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2614
2615 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2616 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2617 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2618
2619 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2620 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2621 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002622 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2623 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2624 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2625 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2626 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002627
2628 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2629
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002630 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2631 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2632 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002633
2634 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2635 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2636 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2637 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2638
2639 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2640 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002641
2642 Example :
2643 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002644 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2645 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646
2647
2648maxconn <conns>
2649 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2651 yes | yes | yes | no
2652 Arguments :
2653 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2654 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2655 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2656 closes.
2657
2658 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2659 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2660 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2661 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2662 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2663 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2664 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2665 properly tuned.
2666
2667 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2668 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2669 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2670
2671 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2672
2673
2674mode { tcp|http|health }
2675 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2677 yes | yes | yes | yes
2678 Arguments :
2679 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2680 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2681 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2682 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2683
2684 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2685 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2686 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2687 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2688 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2689
2690 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2691 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2692 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2693 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2694 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2695 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2696
2697 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2698 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2699 will be refused.
2700
2701 Example :
2702 defaults http_instances
2703 mode http
2704
2705 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002708monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002709 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2711 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712 Arguments :
2713 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2714 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002715 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2717 backend and its backup.
2718
2719 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2720 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2721 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2722 servers in a list of backends.
2723
2724 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2725 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2726 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2727 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2728 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2729 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2730 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002731 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2732 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733
2734 Example:
2735 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002736 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2738 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2739 monitor-uri /site_alive
2740 monitor fail if site_dead
2741
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002742 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002743
2744
2745monitor-net <source>
2746 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2748 yes | yes | yes | no
2749 Arguments :
2750 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2751 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2752 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2753 followed by a mask.
2754
2755 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2756 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002757 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002758 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2759
2760 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2761 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2762 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2763 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2764 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2765
2766 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2767 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2768 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2769 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2770 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2771
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002772 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2773 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2774
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002775 Example :
2776 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2777 frontend www
2778 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2779
2780 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2781
2782
2783monitor-uri <uri>
2784 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2786 yes | yes | yes | no
2787 Arguments :
2788 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2789 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2790
2791 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2792 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2793 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2794 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2795 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2796 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2797 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2798 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2799
2800 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2801 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2802 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2803 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2804 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2805 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2806
2807 Example :
2808 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2809 frontend www
2810 mode http
2811 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2812
2813 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2814
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002816option abortonclose
2817no option abortonclose
2818 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2820 yes | no | yes | yes
2821 Arguments : none
2822
2823 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2824 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2825 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2826 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002827 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002828 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2829 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2830 encountered while delivering the response.
2831
2832 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2833 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2834 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2835 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2836 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2837 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002838 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002839 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002840 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002841 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2842 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2843 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2844
2845 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2846 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2847 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2848 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2849 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2850 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2851 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2852 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002853 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002854
2855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2857
2858 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2859
2860
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002861option accept-invalid-http-request
2862no option accept-invalid-http-request
2863 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2865 yes | yes | yes | no
2866 Arguments : none
2867
2868 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2869 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2870 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2871 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2872 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2873 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2874 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2875 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002876 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2877 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2878 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2879 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2880 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2881 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002882
2883 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2884 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2885 been confirmed.
2886
2887 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2888 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002889 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2890 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002891 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2892
2893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2895
2896 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2897 stats socket.
2898
2899
2900option accept-invalid-http-response
2901no option accept-invalid-http-response
2902 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2904 yes | no | yes | yes
2905 Arguments : none
2906
2907 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2908 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2909 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2910 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2911 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2912 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2913 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2914 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2915 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2916
2917 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2918 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2919 been confirmed.
2920
2921 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2922 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2923 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2924 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2925
2926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2928
2929 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2930 stats socket.
2931
2932
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002933option allbackups
2934no option allbackups
2935 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2937 yes | no | yes | yes
2938 Arguments : none
2939
2940 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2941 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2942 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2943 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2944 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2945 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2946 order between the backup servers anymore.
2947
2948 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2949 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2950
2951 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2952 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2953
2954
2955option checkcache
2956no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002957 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2959 yes | no | yes | yes
2960 Arguments : none
2961
2962 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2963 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002964 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002965 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2966 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002967 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002968
2969 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002970 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002971 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002972 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2973 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002974 to the client are :
2975 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002976 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002977 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002978 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2979 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2980 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2981 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2982 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2983 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2984 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2985 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2986 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2987 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2988 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2989
2990 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002991 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002992 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002993 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002994 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2995
2996 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2997 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002998 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002999 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3000
3001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3003
3004
3005option clitcpka
3006no option clitcpka
3007 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3009 yes | yes | yes | no
3010 Arguments : none
3011
3012 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3013 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3014 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3015 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3016
3017 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3018 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3019 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3020 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3021
3022 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3023 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3024 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3025 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3026 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3027
3028 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3029
3030 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3031 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3032 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3033
3034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3036
3037 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3038
3039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040option contstats
3041 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3043 yes | yes | yes | no
3044 Arguments : none
3045
3046 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3047 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3048 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3049 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3050 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3051 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3052 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3053
3054
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003055option dontlog-normal
3056no option dontlog-normal
3057 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 yes | yes | yes | no
3060 Arguments : none
3061
3062 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3063 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3064 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3065 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3066 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3067 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3068 logged.
3069
3070 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3071 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3072 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003074 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003075 logging.
3076
3077
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003078option dontlognull
3079no option dontlognull
3080 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3082 yes | yes | yes | no
3083 Arguments : none
3084
3085 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3086 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3087 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3088 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3089 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3090 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3091 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3092
3093 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3094 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3095 would not be logged.
3096
3097 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3098 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003100 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003101
3102
3103option forceclose
3104no option forceclose
3105 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003107 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003108 Arguments : none
3109
3110 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3111 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3112 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3113 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3114 global session times in the logs.
3115
3116 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003117 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003118 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3119 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3120 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3121 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003122
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003123 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3124 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3125 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3126
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3129
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003130 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003131
3132
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003133option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003134 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 yes | yes | yes | yes
3137 Arguments :
3138 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3139 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003140 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003141 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003142
3143 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3144 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3145 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3146 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3147 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3148 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3149 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003150 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3151 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3152 possible that the client has already brought one.
3153
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003154 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003155 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003156 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3157 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003158 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3159 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003160
3161 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3162 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3163 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3164 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3165 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3166 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3167 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3168
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003169 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3170 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3171 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3172 are under the control of the end-user.
3173
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003174 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003175 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3176 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003177 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3178 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3179 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003180
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003181 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3182 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3183 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3184 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3185 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003186
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003187 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003188 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3189 frontend www
3190 mode http
3191 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3192
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003193 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3194 backend www
3195 mode http
3196 option forwardfor header X-Client
3197
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003198 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3199 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003200
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003201
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003202option http-no-delay
3203no option http-no-delay
3204 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3206 yes | yes | yes | yes
3207 Arguments : none
3208
3209 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3210 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3211 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3212 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3213 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3214 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3215 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3216 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3217 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3218 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3219 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3220 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3221 affected.
3222
3223 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3224 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3225 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3226 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3227 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3228 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3229 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3230 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3231 latency environments.
3232
3233
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003234option http-pretend-keepalive
3235no option http-pretend-keepalive
3236 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3238 yes | yes | yes | yes
3239 Arguments : none
3240
3241 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3242 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3243 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3244 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3245 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3246 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3247 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3248 consider the response complete.
3249
3250 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3251 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3252 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3253 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3254 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3255 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3256
3257 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3258 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3259 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3260 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3261 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3262 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3263 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3264
3265 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3266 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003267 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3268 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3269 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003270
3271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3273
3274 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3275
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003276
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003277option http-server-close
3278no option http-server-close
3279 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3281 yes | yes | yes | yes
3282 Arguments : none
3283
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003284 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3285 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3286 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3287 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3288 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3289 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3290 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3291 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3292 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3293 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3294 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3295 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003296
3297 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3298 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3299 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3300 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003301 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3302 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003303
3304 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3305 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003306 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3307 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3308 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003309
3310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3312
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003313 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3314 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003315
3316
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003317option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003318no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003319 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3321 yes | yes | yes | no
3322 Arguments : none
3323
3324 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3325 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3326 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3327 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3328 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3329 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3330 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3331
3332 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3333 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3334 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3335 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3336 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3337 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3338 request along its whole life.
3339
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003340 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3341 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3342 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3343 front of an existing proxy.
3344
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003345 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3346
3347 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3348 http-server-close".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003351option httpchk
3352option httpchk <uri>
3353option httpchk <method> <uri>
3354option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3355 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3360 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3361 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3362 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3363 ones.
3364
3365 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3366 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3367 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3368
3369 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3370 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3371 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3372 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3373 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3374
3375 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3376 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3377 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3378 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3379 the lack of any response.
3380
3381 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3382
3383 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3384 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3385 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3386
3387 Examples :
3388 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3389 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3390 backend https_relay
3391 mode tcp
3392 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3393 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3394
3395 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003396 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3397 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003398
3399
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003400option httpclose
3401no option httpclose
3402 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3404 yes | yes | yes | yes
3405 Arguments : none
3406
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003407 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3408 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3409 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3410 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3411 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3412 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3413 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003414
3415 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003416 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3417 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3418 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3419 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3420 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3421 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003422
3423 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3424 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3425 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003426 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3427 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003428
3429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3431
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003432 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3433 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003434
3435
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003436option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003437 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003440 Arguments :
3441 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3442 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3443 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3444 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3445 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003446
3447 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3448 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3449 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3450 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3451 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3452 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3453 ports.
3454
3455 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3456
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3459 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3460 by default.
3461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003462 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003463
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003464
3465option http_proxy
3466no option http_proxy
3467 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3469 yes | yes | yes | yes
3470 Arguments : none
3471
3472 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3473 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3474 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3475 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3476 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3477
3478 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3479 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3480 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3481 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003482 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003483 be analyzed.
3484
3485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3487
3488 Example :
3489 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3490 backend direct_forward
3491 option httpclose
3492 option http_proxy
3493
3494 See also : "option httpclose"
3495
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003496
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003497option independant-streams
3498no option independant-streams
3499 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | yes | yes | yes
3502 Arguments : none
3503
3504 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3505 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3506 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3507 receive data or not.
3508
3509 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3510 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3511 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3512 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3513 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3514 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3515 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3516 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3517 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3518 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3519 socket buffers.
3520
3521 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3522 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3523 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3524 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3525 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3526
3527 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3528
3529
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003530option ldap-check
3531 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3533 yes | no | yes | yes
3534 Arguments : none
3535
3536 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3537 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3538 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3539 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3540
3541 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3542 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3543
3544 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3545 configure it.
3546
3547 Example :
3548 option ldap-check
3549
3550 See also : "option httpchk"
3551
3552
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003553option log-health-checks
3554no option log-health-checks
3555 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | no | yes | yes
3558 Arguments : none
3559
3560 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3561 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3562 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3563 of additional information is limited.
3564
3565 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3566 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3567
3568 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3569
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003570
3571option log-separate-errors
3572no option log-separate-errors
3573 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | yes | yes | no
3576 Arguments : none
3577
3578 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3579 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3580 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3581 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3582 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3583 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3584 provides very important information.
3585
3586 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3587 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3588 error logs.
3589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003590 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003591 logging.
3592
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003593
3594option logasap
3595no option logasap
3596 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3598 yes | yes | yes | no
3599 Arguments : none
3600
3601 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3602 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3603 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3604 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3605 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3606 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3607 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003608 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003609 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3610 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3611
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003612 Examples :
3613 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3614 mode http
3615 option httplog
3616 option logasap
3617 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3618
3619 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3620 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3621 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3622 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003624 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003625 logging.
3626
3627
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003628option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3629 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3631 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003632 Arguments :
3633 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3634 to MySQL server.
3635
3636 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3637 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3638 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3639 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3640 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3641 in the MySQL table, like this :
3642
3643 USE mysql;
3644 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3645 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3646
3647 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3648 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3649 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3650 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3651 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3652 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3653 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3654 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3655 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3656
3657 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3658 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003659
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003660 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003661
3662 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3663 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3664 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3665 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3666 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3667 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3668
3669 See also: "option httpchk"
3670
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003671option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3672 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | no | yes | yes
3675 Arguments :
3676 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3677 to PostgreSQL server.
3678
3679 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3680 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3681 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3682 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3683
3684 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003685
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003686option nolinger
3687no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003688 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003691 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003692
3693 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3694 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3695 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3696 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3697 connections.
3698
3699 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3700 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3701 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3702 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3703 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3704 this too.
3705
3706 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3707 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3708 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3709
3710 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3711 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3712 for servers.
3713
3714 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3715 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3716
3717
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003718option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3719 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | yes
3722 Arguments :
3723 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3724 matching <network>
3725 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3726 header name.
3727
3728 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3729 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3730 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3731 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3732 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3733 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3734 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3735 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3736 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3737 possible that the client has already brought one.
3738
3739 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3740 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3741 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3742 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3743 header and requires different one.
3744
3745 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3746 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3747 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3748 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3749 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3750 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3751 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3752
3753 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3754 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3755 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3756 both are defined.
3757
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003758 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3759 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3760 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3761 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3762 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003763
3764 Examples :
3765 # Original Destination address
3766 frontend www
3767 mode http
3768 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3769
3770 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3771 backend www
3772 mode http
3773 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3774
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003775 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3776 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003777
3778
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003779option persist
3780no option persist
3781 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3783 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003784 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003785
3786 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3787 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3788 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3789 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3790 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3791 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3792 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3793 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3794 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3795 redirected to another valid server.
3796
3797 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3798 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3799
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003800 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003801
3802
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003803option redispatch
3804no option redispatch
3805 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003808 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003809
3810 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3811 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3812 be able to access the service anymore.
3813
3814 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3815 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3816
3817 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3818 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3819 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003821 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3822 "redisp" keywords.
3823
3824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3826
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003827 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003828
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003829
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003830option redis-check
3831 Use redis health checks for server testing
3832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3833 yes | no | yes | yes
3834 Arguments : none
3835
3836 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3837 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3838 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3839 find the "+PONG" response message.
3840
3841 Example :
3842 option redis-check
3843
3844 See also : "option httpchk"
3845
3846
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003847option smtpchk
3848option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3849 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003852 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003853 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3854 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3855 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3856
3857 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3858 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3859 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3860
3861 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3862 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3863 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3864 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3865 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3866 dead server.
3867
3868 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3869 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3870 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3871 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3872
3873 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3874 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3875 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3876 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3877 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3878
3879 Example :
3880 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3881
3882 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003885option socket-stats
3886no option socket-stats
3887
3888 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3890 yes | yes | yes | no
3891
3892 Arguments : none
3893
3894
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003895option splice-auto
3896no option splice-auto
3897 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3899 yes | yes | yes | yes
3900 Arguments : none
3901
3902 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3903 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3904 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3905 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003906 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003907 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3908 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3909 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3910 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3911
3912 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3913 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3914 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3915 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3916 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3917 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3918 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3919 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3920 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3921 keyword.
3922
3923 Example :
3924 option splice-auto
3925
3926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3928
3929 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3930 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3931
3932
3933option splice-request
3934no option splice-request
3935 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3937 yes | yes | yes | yes
3938 Arguments : none
3939
3940 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3941 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3942 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3943 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3944 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3945 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3946
3947 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3948
3949 Example :
3950 option splice-request
3951
3952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3954
3955 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3956 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3957
3958
3959option splice-response
3960no option splice-response
3961 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3963 yes | yes | yes | yes
3964 Arguments : none
3965
3966 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3967 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3968 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3969 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3970 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3971 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3972
3973 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3974
3975 Example :
3976 option splice-response
3977
3978 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3979 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3980
3981 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3982 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3983
3984
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003985option srvtcpka
3986no option srvtcpka
3987 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3989 yes | no | yes | yes
3990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3993 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3994 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3995 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3996
3997 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3998 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3999 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4000 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4001
4002 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4003 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4004 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4005 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4006 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4007
4008 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4009
4010 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4011 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4012 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4013
4014 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4015 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4016
4017 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4018
4019
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004020option ssl-hello-chk
4021 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4023 yes | no | yes | yes
4024 Arguments : none
4025
4026 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4027 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4028 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4029 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4030 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4031 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4032 hello message.
4033
4034 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4035 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4036 messages, which is appreciable.
4037
4038 See also: "option httpchk"
4039
4040
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004041option tcp-smart-accept
4042no option tcp-smart-accept
4043 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | no
4046 Arguments : none
4047
4048 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4049 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4050 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4051 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4052 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4053 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4054
4055 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4056 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4057 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4058 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4059
4060 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4061 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4062 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4063 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4064
4065 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4066 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4067 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4068
4069 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4070 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4071 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4072
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004073 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4074
4075
4076option tcp-smart-connect
4077no option tcp-smart-connect
4078 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4080 yes | no | yes | yes
4081 Arguments : none
4082
4083 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4084 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4085 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4086 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4087 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4088
4089 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4090 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4091 complex.
4092
4093 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4094 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4095 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4096
4097 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4098 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4099
4100 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4101
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004102
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004103option tcpka
4104 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4106 yes | yes | yes | yes
4107 Arguments : none
4108
4109 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4110 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4111 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4112 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4113
4114 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4115 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4116 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4117 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4118
4119 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4120 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4121 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4122 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4123 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4124
4125 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4126
4127 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4128 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4129 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4130 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4131 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4132 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4133 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4134 backends.
4135
4136 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4137
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004138
4139option tcplog
4140 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 yes | yes | yes | yes
4143 Arguments : none
4144
4145 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4146 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4147 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4148 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4149 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4150 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4151 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4152 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4153
4154 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004156 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004157
4158
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004159option transparent
4160no option transparent
4161 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004163 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004164 Arguments : none
4165
4166 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4167 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4168 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4169 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4170 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4171 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4172 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4173 appropriate server.
4174
4175 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4176 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4177
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004178 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004179 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004180
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004181
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004182persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004183persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004184 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4186 yes | no | yes | yes
4187 Arguments :
4188 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004189 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4190 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004191
4192 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4193 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4194 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4195 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4196 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4197 forwarded to this server.
4198
4199 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4200 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4201 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004202 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004203 a single "listen" section.
4204
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004205 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4206 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4207 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4208
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004209 Example :
4210 listen tse-farm
4211 bind :3389
4212 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4213 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4214 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4215 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4216 persist rdp-cookie
4217 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4218 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4219 balance rdp-cookie
4220 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4221 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4222
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004223 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4224 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004225
4226
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004227rate-limit sessions <rate>
4228 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4230 yes | yes | yes | no
4231 Arguments :
4232 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4233 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4234
4235 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4236 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4237 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4238 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4239 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4240 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4241
4242 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4243 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4244 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4245 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4246
4247 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4248 listen smtp
4249 mode tcp
4250 bind :25
4251 rate-limit sessions 10
4252 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4253
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004254 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4255 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4256 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004257
4258 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4259
4260
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004261redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4262redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004263 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4265 no | yes | yes | yes
4266
4267 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004268 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004269
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004270 Arguments :
4271 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4272 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4273 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4274 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004275 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4276 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4277 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4278 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004279
4280 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4281 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4282 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4283 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4284 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4285 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4286 location with a GET method.
4287
4288 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4289 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4290
4291 - "drop-query"
4292 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4293 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4294 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4295 with a location-type redirect.
4296
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004297 - "append-slash"
4298 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4299 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4300 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4301 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4302
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004303 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4304 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4305 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4306 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4307 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4308 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4309 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4310
4311 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4312 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4313 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4314 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4315 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4316 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4317 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004318
4319 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4320 acl clear dst_port 80
4321 acl secure dst_port 8080
4322 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004323 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004324 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004325 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4326
4327 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004328 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4329 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4330 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004331 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004332
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004333 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4334 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4335 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004337 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004338
4339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004340redisp (deprecated)
4341redispatch (deprecated)
4342 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4343 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4344 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004345 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004346
4347 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4348 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4349 be able to access the service anymore.
4350
4351 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4352 redistribute them to a working server.
4353
4354 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4355 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4356 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004358 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4359 "option redispatch" instead.
4360
4361 See also : "option redispatch"
4362
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004363
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004364reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004365 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 no | yes | yes | yes
4368 Arguments :
4369 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4370 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004371 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004372
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004373 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4374 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4375
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004376 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4377 the last header of an HTTP request.
4378
4379 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4380 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4381 responses.
4382
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004383 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4384 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4385 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4386
4387 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4388 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004389
4390
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004391reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4392reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004393 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 no | yes | yes | yes
4396 Arguments :
4397 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4398 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4399 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4400 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4401 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4402 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4403 ignores case.
4404
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004405 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4406 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4407
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004408 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4409 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4410 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4411 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004412 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004413
4414 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4415 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4416
4417 Example :
4418 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4419 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4420 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4421
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004422 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4423 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004424
4425
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004426reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4427reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004428 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4430 no | yes | yes | yes
4431 Arguments :
4432 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4433 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4434 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4435 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4436 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4437 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4438
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004439 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4440 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4441
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004442 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4443 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4444 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4445 next servers.
4446
4447 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4448 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4449 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4450
4451 Example :
4452 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4453 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4454 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4455
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004456 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4457 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004458
4459
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004460reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4461reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004462 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4464 no | yes | yes | yes
4465 Arguments :
4466 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4467 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4468 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4469 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4470 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4471 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4472 case.
4473
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004474 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4475 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4476
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004477 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4478 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4479 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4480 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004481 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004482
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004483 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004484 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004485 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004486
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004487 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4488 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4489
4490 Example :
4491 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4492 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4493 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4494
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004495 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4496 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004497
4498
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004499reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4500reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004501 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 no | yes | yes | yes
4504 Arguments :
4505 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4506 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4507 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4508 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4509 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4510 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4511 case.
4512
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004513 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4514 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4515
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004516 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4517 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4518 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4519 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4520
4521 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4522 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4523
4524 Example :
4525 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4526 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4527 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4528 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4529
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004530 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4531 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004532
4533
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004534reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4535reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004536 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4538 no | yes | yes | yes
4539 Arguments :
4540 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4541 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4542 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4543 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4544 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4545 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4546
4547 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4548 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4549 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4550 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004551 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004553 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4554 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4555
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004556 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4557 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4558 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4559
4560 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4561 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4562 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4563 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4564 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4565
4566 Example :
4567 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4568 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4569 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4570 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4571
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004572 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4573 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004574
4575
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004576reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4577reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 no | yes | yes | yes
4581 Arguments :
4582 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4583 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4584 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4585 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4586 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4587 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4588 ignores case.
4589
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004590 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4591 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4592
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004593 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4594 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004595 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4596 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4597 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004598 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4599 not set.
4600
4601 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4602 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4603 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4604 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4605 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4606
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004607 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004608 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4609 # block all others.
4610 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4611 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004613 # block bad guys
4614 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4615 reqitarpit . if badguys
4616
4617 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4618 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004619
4620
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004621retries <value>
4622 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 yes | no | yes | yes
4625 Arguments :
4626 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4627 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4628 default value is 3.
4629
4630 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4631 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4632 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4633
4634 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4635 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4636
4637 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4638 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4639
4640 See also : "option redispatch"
4641
4642
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004643rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004644 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 no | yes | yes | yes
4647 Arguments :
4648 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4649 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004650 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004651
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004652 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4653 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4654
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004655 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4656 the last header of an HTTP response.
4657
4658 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4659 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4660 responses.
4661
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004662 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4663 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004664
4665
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004666rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4667rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004668 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 no | yes | yes | yes
4671 Arguments :
4672 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4673 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4674 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4675 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4676 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4677 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4678 ignores case.
4679
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004680 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4681 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4682
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004683 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4684 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004685 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004686 client.
4687
4688 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4689 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4690 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4691
4692 Example :
4693 # remove the Server header from responses
4694 reqidel ^Server:.*
4695
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004696 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4697 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004698
4699
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004700rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4701rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004702 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4704 no | yes | yes | yes
4705 Arguments :
4706 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4707 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4708 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4709 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4710 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4711 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4712 ignores case.
4713
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004714 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4715 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4716
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004717 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4718 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4719 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4720 case-sensitive.
4721
4722 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004723 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4724 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4725 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004726
4727 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4728 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4729
4730 Example :
4731 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4732 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4733
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004734 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4735 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004736
4737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004738rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4739rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004740 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 no | yes | yes | yes
4743 Arguments :
4744 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4745 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4746 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4747 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4748 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4749 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4750 ignores case.
4751
4752 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4753 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4754 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4755 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004756 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004757
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004758 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4759 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4760
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004761 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4762 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4763 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4764
4765 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4766 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4767 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4768 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4769 are not case-sensitive.
4770
4771 Example :
4772 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4773 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4774
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004775 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4776 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004777
4778
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004779server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004780 Declare a server in a backend
4781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4782 no | no | yes | yes
4783 Arguments :
4784 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004785 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4786 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004787
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004788 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4789 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4790 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4791 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004792 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4793 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4794 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4795 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4796 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4797 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004798
4799 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4800 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4801 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4802 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4803 adding this value to the client's port.
4804
4805 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4806 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004807 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004808
4809 Examples :
4810 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4811 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4812
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004813 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4814 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004815
4816
4817source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004818source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004819source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004820 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | no | yes | yes
4823 Arguments :
4824 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4825 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4826 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4827 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4828
4829 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4830 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004831 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4832 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4833 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004834
4835 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4836 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4837 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4838 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4839 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4840 <addr>.
4841
4842 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4843 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4844 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4845 port.
4846
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004847 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4848 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4849 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4850 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4851 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4852 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4853 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4854 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4855 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4856 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4857 HTTP header.
4858
4859 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4860 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4861 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4862 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4863 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4864 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4865 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4866 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4867 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4868 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4869
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004870 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4871 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4872 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4873 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4874 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4875 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4876
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004877 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4878 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4879 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4880 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4881
4882 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4883 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4884 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4885 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4886 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4887 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4888
4889 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4890 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4891 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4892 there are two methods :
4893
4894 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4895 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4896 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4897 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4898 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4899 of the client ranges may be used.
4900
4901 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4902 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4903 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4904 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4905 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4906 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4907 same session.
4908
4909 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4910 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4911 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4912 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4913 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4914 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4915
4916 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4917 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4918 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004919 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004920
4921 Examples :
4922 backend private
4923 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4924 source 192.168.1.200
4925
4926 backend transparent_ssl1
4927 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4928 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4929
4930 backend transparent_ssl2
4931 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4932 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4933 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4934
4935 backend transparent_ssl3
4936 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4937 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4938 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4939
4940 backend transparent_smtp
4941 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4942 # with Tproxy version 4.
4943 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4944
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004945 backend transparent_http
4946 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4947 # proxy.
4948 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004950 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004951 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004953
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004954srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4955 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | no | yes | yes
4958 Arguments :
4959 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4960 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4961 as explained at the top of this document.
4962
4963 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4964 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4965 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4966 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4967 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4968 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4969 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4970
4971 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4972 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4973 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4974 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4975 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004976 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004977 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004978 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004979
4980 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4981 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4982 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4983 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4984 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4985 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4986
4987 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4988 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4989
4990 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4991
4992
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004993stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4994 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4996 no | no | yes | yes
4997
4998 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4999 matched.
5000
5001 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5002 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5003
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005004 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5005 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5006 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5007
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005008 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5009 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5010 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5011 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005012
5013 Example :
5014 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5015 backend stats_localhost
5016 stats enable
5017 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5018
5019 Example :
5020 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5021 backend stats_auth
5022 stats enable
5023 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5024 stats admin if TRUE
5025
5026 Example :
5027 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5028 userlist stats-auth
5029 group admin users admin
5030 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5031 group readonly users haproxy
5032 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5033
5034 backend stats_auth
5035 stats enable
5036 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5037 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5038 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5039 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5040
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005041 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5042 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5043 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005044
5045
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005046stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5047 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 yes | no | yes | yes
5050 Arguments :
5051 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5052
5053 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5054
5055 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5056 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5057 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5058 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5059 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5060 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5061
5062 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5063 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5064 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005065 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005066
5067 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5068 report using "stats scope".
5069
5070 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5071 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5072 unobvious parameters.
5073
5074 Example :
5075 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5076 backend public_www
5077 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5078 stats enable
5079 stats hide-version
5080 stats scope .
5081 stats uri /admin?stats
5082 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5083 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5084 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5085
5086 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5087 backend private_monitoring
5088 stats enable
5089 stats uri /admin?stats
5090 stats refresh 5s
5091
5092 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5093
5094
5095stats enable
5096 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | no | yes | yes
5099 Arguments : none
5100
5101 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5102 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5103 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5104 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5105 - stats auth : no authentication
5106 - stats scope : no restriction
5107
5108 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5109 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5110 unobvious parameters.
5111
5112 Example :
5113 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5114 backend public_www
5115 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5116 stats enable
5117 stats hide-version
5118 stats scope .
5119 stats uri /admin?stats
5120 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5121 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5122 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5123
5124 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5125 backend private_monitoring
5126 stats enable
5127 stats uri /admin?stats
5128 stats refresh 5s
5129
5130 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5131
5132
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005133stats hide-version
5134 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005137 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005139 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5140 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5141 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5142 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5143 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5144 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005145
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005146 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5147 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5148 unobvious parameters.
5149
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005150 Example :
5151 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5152 backend public_www
5153 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005154 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005155 stats hide-version
5156 stats scope .
5157 stats uri /admin?stats
5158 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5159 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5160 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005161
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005162 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5163 backend private_monitoring
5164 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005165 stats uri /admin?stats
5166 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005168 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005169
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005170
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005171stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5172 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5173 Access control for statistics
5174
5175 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 no | no | yes | yes
5177
5178 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5179 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5180 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5181 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5182 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5183 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5184
5185 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5186 instance.
5187
5188 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5189 about ACL usage.
5190
5191
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005192stats realm <realm>
5193 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | no | yes | yes
5196 Arguments :
5197 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5198 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5199 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5200
5201 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5202 using a backslash ('\').
5203
5204 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5205 only related to authentication.
5206
5207 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5208 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5209 unobvious parameters.
5210
5211 Example :
5212 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5213 backend public_www
5214 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5215 stats enable
5216 stats hide-version
5217 stats scope .
5218 stats uri /admin?stats
5219 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5220 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5221 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5222
5223 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5224 backend private_monitoring
5225 stats enable
5226 stats uri /admin?stats
5227 stats refresh 5s
5228
5229 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5230
5231
5232stats refresh <delay>
5233 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5235 yes | no | yes | yes
5236 Arguments :
5237 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5238 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5239 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5240 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5241 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5242 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5243
5244 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5245 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5246 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5247 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5248
5249 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5250 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5251 unobvious parameters.
5252
5253 Example :
5254 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5255 backend public_www
5256 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5257 stats enable
5258 stats hide-version
5259 stats scope .
5260 stats uri /admin?stats
5261 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5262 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5263 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5264
5265 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5266 backend private_monitoring
5267 stats enable
5268 stats uri /admin?stats
5269 stats refresh 5s
5270
5271 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5272
5273
5274stats scope { <name> | "." }
5275 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5277 yes | no | yes | yes
5278 Arguments :
5279 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5280 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5281 section in which the statement appears.
5282
5283 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5284 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5285 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5286 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5287 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5288 exists.
5289
5290 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5291 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5292 unobvious parameters.
5293
5294 Example :
5295 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5296 backend public_www
5297 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5298 stats enable
5299 stats hide-version
5300 stats scope .
5301 stats uri /admin?stats
5302 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5303 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5304 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5305
5306 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5307 backend private_monitoring
5308 stats enable
5309 stats uri /admin?stats
5310 stats refresh 5s
5311
5312 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005314
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005315stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005316 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 yes | no | yes | yes
5319
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005320 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005321 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5322
5323 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5324 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5325
5326 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5327 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5328 unobvious parameters.
5329
5330 Example :
5331 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5332 backend private_monitoring
5333 stats enable
5334 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5335 stats uri /admin?stats
5336 stats refresh 5s
5337
5338 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5339 global section.
5340
5341
5342stats show-legends
5343 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5344 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5345 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5346 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5347 - IP (socket, server)
5348 - cookie (backend, server)
5349
5350 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5351 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5352 unobvious parameters.
5353
5354 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5355
5356
5357stats show-node [ <name> ]
5358 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 yes | no | yes | yes
5361 Arguments:
5362 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5363 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5364
5365 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5366 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5367 provided for each customer.
5368
5369 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5370 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5371 unobvious parameters.
5372
5373 Example:
5374 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5375 backend private_monitoring
5376 stats enable
5377 stats show-node Europe-1
5378 stats uri /admin?stats
5379 stats refresh 5s
5380
5381 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5382 section.
5383
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005384
5385stats uri <prefix>
5386 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 yes | no | yes | yes
5389 Arguments :
5390 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5391 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5392 query string.
5393
5394 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5395 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5396 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5397 possible to reach it in the application.
5398
5399 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005400 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005401 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5402 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5403 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5404 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5405
5406 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5407 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5408 an address or a port to statistics only.
5409
5410 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5411 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5412 unobvious parameters.
5413
5414 Example :
5415 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5416 backend public_www
5417 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5418 stats enable
5419 stats hide-version
5420 stats scope .
5421 stats uri /admin?stats
5422 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5423 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5424 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5425
5426 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5427 backend private_monitoring
5428 stats enable
5429 stats uri /admin?stats
5430 stats refresh 5s
5431
5432 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5433
5434
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005435stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5436 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005438 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005439
5440 Arguments :
5441 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5442 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5443 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5444 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5445
5446 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5447 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5448 the "stick-table" statement.
5449
5450 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5451 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5452 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5453 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5454 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5455
5456 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5457 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5458 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5459 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5460 transformation rules.
5461
5462 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5463 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5464 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5465 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5466 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5467 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5468 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5469
5470 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5471 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5472 ACL based conditions.
5473
5474 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5475 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5476 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5477 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5478
5479 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5480 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5481 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5482 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5483
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005484 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5485 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5486 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5487
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005488 Example :
5489 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5490 # last 30 minutes
5491 backend pop
5492 mode tcp
5493 balance roundrobin
5494 stick store-request src
5495 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5496 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5497 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5498
5499 backend smtp
5500 mode tcp
5501 balance roundrobin
5502 stick match src table pop
5503 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5504 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5505
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005506 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5507 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005508
5509
5510stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5511 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5513 no | no | yes | yes
5514
5515 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5516 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5517 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5518 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5519
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005520 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5521 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5522 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5523
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005524 Examples :
5525 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005526 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005527
5528 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5529 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5530 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5531
5532
5533 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5534 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5535 backend http
5536 mode http
5537 balance roundrobin
5538 stick on src table https
5539 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5540 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5541 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5542
5543 backend https
5544 mode tcp
5545 balance roundrobin
5546 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5547 stick on src
5548 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5549 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5550
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005551 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005552
5553
5554stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5555 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5557 no | no | yes | yes
5558
5559 Arguments :
5560 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5561 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5562 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5563 server is selected.
5564
5565 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5566 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5567 the "stick-table" statement.
5568
5569 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5570 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5571 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5572 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5573 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5574 address.
5575
5576 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5577 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5578 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5579 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5580 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5581 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5582 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5583 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5584 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5585 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5586
5587 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5588 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5589 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5590 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5591 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5592 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5593 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5594
5595 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5596 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5597 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5598 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5599
5600 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5601 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5602 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5603 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5604 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5605 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5606 another protocol or access method.
5607
5608 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5609 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5610 the request.
5611
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005612 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5613 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5614 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5615
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005616 Example :
5617 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5618 # last 30 minutes
5619 backend pop
5620 mode tcp
5621 balance roundrobin
5622 stick store-request src
5623 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5624 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5625 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5626
5627 backend smtp
5628 mode tcp
5629 balance roundrobin
5630 stick match src table pop
5631 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5632 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5633
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005634 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5635 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005636
5637
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005638stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005639 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5640 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005641 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005643 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005644
5645 Arguments :
5646 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5647 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5648 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5649 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5650
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005651 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5652 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5653 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5654 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5655
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005656 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5657 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5658 instance.
5659
5660 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5661 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5662 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5663 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5664 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5665 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005666 to 32 characters.
5667
5668 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5669 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5670 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5671 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5672 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5673 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005674
5675 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005676 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5677 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005678 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5679 increase.
5680
5681 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005682 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5683 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5684 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005685
5686 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5687 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5688 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5689 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5690 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5691 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5692 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5693 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5694 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5695 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5696 parameter (see below).
5697
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005698 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5699 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5700 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5701 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5702 soft restart.
5703
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005704 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5705
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005706 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5707 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5708 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5709 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5710 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5711 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5712 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5713 if not expiration delay is specified.
5714
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005715 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5716 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5717 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5718 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005719 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5720 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5721 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5722 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5723 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5724 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5725 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5726 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5727 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5728 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5729 types and their arguments.
5730
5731 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5732 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5733 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5734 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5735
5736 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5737 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5738 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5739 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5740
5741 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5742 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5743 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5744 they were received.
5745
5746 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5747 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5748 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5749 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5750 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5751
5752 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5753 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5754 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5755 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5756 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5757
5758 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5759 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5760 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5761
5762 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5763 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5764 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5765 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5766 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5767
5768 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5769 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5770 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5771 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5772 the client side.
5773
5774 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5775 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5776 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5777 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5778 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5779 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5780 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5781
5782 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5783 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5784 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5785 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5786 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5787 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5788 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5789
5790 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5791 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5792 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5793 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5794 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5795 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5796
5797 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5798 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5799 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5800 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5801
5802 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5803 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5804 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5805 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5806 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5807 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5808 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5809 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5810 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5811 recommended for better fairness.
5812
5813 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5814 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5815 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5816 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5817
5818 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5819 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5820 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5821 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5822 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5823 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5824 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5825 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5826 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5827 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005828
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005829 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5830 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005831 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5832 reference it.
5833
5834 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5835 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5836 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5837 as an exclusive stickiness.
5838
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005839 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5840 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5841 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5842 something that can be ignored.
5843
5844 Example:
5845 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5846 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5847 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5848 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5849
5850 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005851 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005852
5853
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005854stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5855 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 no | no | yes | yes
5858
5859 Arguments :
5860 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5861 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5862 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5863 server is selected.
5864
5865 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5866 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5867 the "stick-table" statement.
5868
5869 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5870 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5871 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5872 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5873
5874 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5875 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5876 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5877 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5878 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5879 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5880 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5881 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5882 rules.
5883
5884 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5885 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5886 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5887 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5888 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5889 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5890 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5891
5892 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5893 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5894 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5895 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5896
5897 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5898 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5899 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5900 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5901 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5902 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5903 another protocol or access method.
5904
5905 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5906
5907 Example :
5908 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5909 backend https
5910 mode tcp
5911 balance roundrobin
5912 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5913 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5914
5915 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5916 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5917
5918 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5919 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5920 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5921
5922 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5923 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5924
5925 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5926 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5927 # at offset 44.
5928
5929 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5930 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5931
5932 # Learn on response if server hello.
5933 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5934
5935 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5936 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5937
5938 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5939 extraction.
5940
5941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005942tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5943 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005946 Arguments :
5947 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5948 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5949 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005950
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005951 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005952
5953 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5954 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005955 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5956 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5957 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5958 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5959 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5960 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005962 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5963 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5964 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5965 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005967 Three types of actions are supported :
5968 - accept :
5969 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5970 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5971 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 - reject :
5974 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5975 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5976 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5977 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5978 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5979 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5980 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5981 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5982 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5983 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5984 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5985 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005986
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005987 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5988 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5989 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5990 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5991 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5992 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5993 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5994 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5995 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005997 These actions take one or two arguments :
5998 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5999 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6000 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006002 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6003 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6004 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6005 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006007 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6008 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6009 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6010 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6011 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6012 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6013 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6014 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6015 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6016 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006018 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6019 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6020 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006022 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6023 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6024 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006026 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006027 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006030 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6031 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6032 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006034 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6035 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6036 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006037
6038 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006041
6042
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006043tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6044 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006046 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006047 Arguments :
6048 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6049 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6050 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006052 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006054 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6055 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6056 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6057 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6058 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6061 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6062 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6063 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6064 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6065 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6066 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6067 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6068 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006070 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6071 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6072 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6073 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006075 Three types of actions are supported :
6076 - accept :
6077 - reject :
6078 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006079
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006080 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6081 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006083 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6084 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6085 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6086 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6087 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6088 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006090 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006091 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6092 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006094 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6095 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6096 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6097 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6098 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006099
6100 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6102 # and reject everything else.
6103 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6104 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6105 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6106 tcp-request content reject
6107
6108 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006109 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6110 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6111 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006112 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006113
6114 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6115 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6116 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006117 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006118 tcp-request content reject
6119
6120 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6121 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6122
6123 frontend http
6124 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6125 # protecting all our sites
6126 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6127 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6128 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6129 ...
6130 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6131
6132 backend http_dynamic
6133 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6134 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6135 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6136 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6137 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6138 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6139 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006141 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006143 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006144
6145
6146tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6147 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006149 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006150 Arguments :
6151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6153 as explained at the top of this document.
6154
6155 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6156 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6157 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6158 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6159 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6160
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006161 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6162 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6163 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6164 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6165
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006166 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6167 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006168 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006169 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006170 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6171 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6172 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6173 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006174
6175 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6176 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6177 it pass through unaffected.
6178
6179 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6180 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6181 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006182 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006183 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6184 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006185 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6186 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6187 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006189 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006190 "timeout client".
6191
6192
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006193tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6194 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6196 no | no | yes | yes
6197 Arguments :
6198 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6199 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6200 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6201
6202 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6203
6204 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6205 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6206 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6207 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6208 set and expires with no matching rule.
6209
6210 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6211
6212 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6213 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6214 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6215 inserted.
6216
6217 Two types of actions are supported :
6218 - accept :
6219 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6220 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6221 the rules evaluation.
6222
6223 - reject :
6224 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6225 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6226 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6227
6228 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6229 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6230 for changing the default action to a reject.
6231
6232 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6233 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6234 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6235 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6236 period.
6237
6238 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6239
6240 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6241
6242
6243tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6244 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6246 no | no | yes | yes
6247 Arguments :
6248 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6249 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6250 as explained at the top of this document.
6251
6252 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6253
6254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006255timeout check <timeout>
6256 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6257 established.
6258
6259 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6260 yes | no | yes | yes
6261 Arguments:
6262 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6263 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6264 as explained at the top of this document.
6265
6266 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6267 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6268 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6269 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006270 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6271 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6272 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006273
6274 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6275 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6276
6277 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6278 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006279 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006280
6281 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6282 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6283 forget about it.
6284
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006285 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6286 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006287
6288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006289timeout client <timeout>
6290timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6291 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | yes | yes | no
6294 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6297 as explained at the top of this document.
6298
6299 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6300 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6301 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6302 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6303 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6304 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6305 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6306 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006307 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006308 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6309 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6310
6311 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6312 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6313 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6314 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6315 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6316 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6317
6318 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6319 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6320 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6321
6322 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6323
6324
6325timeout connect <timeout>
6326timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6327 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6329 yes | no | yes | yes
6330 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006331 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006332 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6333 as explained at the top of this document.
6334
6335 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006336 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006337 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006338 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006339 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6340 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006341
6342 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6343 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6344 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6345 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6346 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6347 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6348
6349 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6350 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6351 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6352
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006353 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6354 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006355
6356
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006357timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6358 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | yes | yes | yes
6361 Arguments :
6362 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6363 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6364 as explained at the top of this document.
6365
6366 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6367 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6368 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6369 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6370 once the request has started to present itself.
6371
6372 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6373 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6374 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6375 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6376 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6377
6378 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6379 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6380 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6381 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6382
6383 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6384 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6385 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6386 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6387 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006388 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006389
6390 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6391 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6392 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6393 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6394
6395 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6396
6397
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006398timeout http-request <timeout>
6399 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006401 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006402 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006403 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6405 as explained at the top of this document.
6406
6407 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6408 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6409 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6410 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6411 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6412 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6413 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6414 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6415
6416 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6417 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006418 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6419 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006420
6421 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6422 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6423 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6424 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6425 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6426
6427 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006428 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6429 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6430 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006431
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006432 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006433
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006434
6435timeout queue <timeout>
6436 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6438 yes | no | yes | yes
6439 Arguments :
6440 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6441 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6442 as explained at the top of this document.
6443
6444 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6445 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6446 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6447 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6448 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6449
6450 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6451 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6452 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6453 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6454
6455 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6456
6457
6458timeout server <timeout>
6459timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6460 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6462 yes | no | yes | yes
6463 Arguments :
6464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6466 as explained at the top of this document.
6467
6468 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6469 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6470 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6471 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6472 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6473 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6474 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6475
6476 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6477 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6478 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6479 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6480 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006481 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006482 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006483 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006484
6485 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6486 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6487 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6488 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6489 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6490 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6491
6492 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6493 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6494 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6495
6496 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6497
6498
6499timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006500 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | yes | yes | yes
6503 Arguments :
6504 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6505 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6506 as explained at the top of this document.
6507
6508 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6509 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6510 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6511
6512 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6513 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6514 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6515 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006516 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006517
6518 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6519
6520
6521transparent (deprecated)
6522 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006524 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006525 Arguments : none
6526
6527 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6528 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6529 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6530 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6531 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6532 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6533 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6534 appropriate server.
6535
6536 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6537
6538 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6539 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6540
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006541 See also: "option transparent"
6542
6543
6544use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6545use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006546 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6548 no | yes | yes | no
6549 Arguments :
6550 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006552 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006553
6554 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6555 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6556 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006557 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6558 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6559 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6560 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006561
6562 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6563 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6564 assign the backend.
6565
6566 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6567 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6568 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6569 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6570 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6571 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6572
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006573 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006574 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006575 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6576 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6577 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6578
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006579 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006580
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010065825. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006583------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006585The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6586which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6587arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6588settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6589after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6590Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6591address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006593 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006594 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006596The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006598addr <ipv4>
6599 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6600 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6601 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6602 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6603 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006605 Supported in default-server: No
6606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006607backup
6608 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6609 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6610 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6611 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6612 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6613 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006615 Supported in default-server: No
6616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006617check
6618 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006619 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6620 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6621 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6622 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6623 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6624 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6625 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6626 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6627 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6628 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006630 Supported in default-server: No
6631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006632cookie <value>
6633 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6634 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6635 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6636 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6637 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6638 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6639 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006641 Supported in default-server: No
6642
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006643disabled
6644 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6645 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6646 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6647 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6648 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6649
6650 Supported in default-server: No
6651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006652error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006653 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6654 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6655 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006657 Supported in default-server: Yes
6658
6659 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006661fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006662 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6663 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6664 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006666 Supported in default-server: Yes
6667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006668id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006669 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6670 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6671 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006673 Supported in default-server: No
6674
6675inter <delay>
6676fastinter <delay>
6677downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006678 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6679 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6680 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6681 between checks depending on the server state :
6682
6683 Server state | Interval used
6684 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6685 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6686 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6687 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6688 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6689 or yet unchecked. |
6690 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6691 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6692 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006694 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6695 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6696 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6697 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6698 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6699 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6700 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6701 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6702 servers.
6703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006704 Supported in default-server: Yes
6705
6706maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006707 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6708 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6709 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6710 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6711 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6712 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6713 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6714 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006716 Supported in default-server: Yes
6717
6718maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006719 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6720 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6721 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6722 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6723 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6724 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6725 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006727 Supported in default-server: Yes
6728
6729minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006730 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6731 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6732 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6733 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6734 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6735 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006736 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006737 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006739 Supported in default-server: Yes
6740
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006741non-stick
6742 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6743 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6744 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006746observe <mode>
6747 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6748 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6749 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6750 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6751 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6752 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6753 headers, a timeout, etc.
6754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006755 Supported in default-server: No
6756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006757 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006759on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006760 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6761 Currently, four modes are available:
6762 - fastinter: force fastinter
6763 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6764 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6765 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6766 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006768 Supported in default-server: Yes
6769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006770 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6771
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006772on-marked-down <action>
6773 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6774 Currently one action is available:
6775 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6776
6777 Actions are disabled by default
6778
6779 Supported in default-server: Yes
6780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006781port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006782 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6783 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6784 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6785 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6786 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6787 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006789 Supported in default-server: Yes
6790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006791redir <prefix>
6792 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6793 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6794 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6795 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6796 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6797 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6798 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6799 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006800 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006801 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6802 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6803 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6804 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6805 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6806
6807 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006809 Supported in default-server: No
6810
6811rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006812 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6813 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6814 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006816 Supported in default-server: Yes
6817
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006818send-proxy
6819 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6820 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6821 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6822 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6823 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6824 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6825 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6826 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6827 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6828 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6829 option of the "bind" keyword.
6830
6831 Supported in default-server: No
6832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006833slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006834 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6835 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6836 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6837 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6838 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6839 parameters :
6840
6841 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6842 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6843
6844 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6845 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6846 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6847 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6848
6849 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6850 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6851 seen as failed.
6852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006853 Supported in default-server: Yes
6854
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006855source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006856source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006857source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006858 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6859 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6860 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6861 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6862
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006863 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6864 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6865 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6866 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6867 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6868 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6869 server.
6870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006871 Supported in default-server: No
6872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006873track [<proxy>/]<server>
6874 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6875 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6876 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6877 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6878 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006880 Supported in default-server: No
6881
6882weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006883 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6884 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6885 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006886 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6887 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6888 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6889 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6890 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6891 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006893 Supported in default-server: Yes
6894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006895
68966. HTTP header manipulation
6897---------------------------
6898
6899In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6900response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6901request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6902which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6903against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6904to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6905passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6906headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6907never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6908
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006909There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6910(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6911rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6912messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6913in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006914happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006915add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6916normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006918This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6919in section 4.2 :
6920
6921 - reqadd <string>
6922 - reqallow <search>
6923 - reqiallow <search>
6924 - reqdel <search>
6925 - reqidel <search>
6926 - reqdeny <search>
6927 - reqideny <search>
6928 - reqpass <search>
6929 - reqipass <search>
6930 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6931 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6932 - reqtarpit <search>
6933 - reqitarpit <search>
6934 - rspadd <string>
6935 - rspdel <search>
6936 - rspidel <search>
6937 - rspdeny <search>
6938 - rspideny <search>
6939 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6940 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6941
6942With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6943is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6944parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6945prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6946Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6947
6948 \t for a tab
6949 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6950 \n for a new line (LF)
6951 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6952 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6953 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6954 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6955 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6956
6957The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6958portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6959above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6960regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
69619 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6962is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6963
6964The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6965after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6966
6967Notes related to these keywords :
6968---------------------------------
6969 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6970 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6971 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6972
6973 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6974 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6975 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6976
6977 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6978 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6979 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6980 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6981 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6982
6983 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6984 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6985 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6986 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6987 useless headers before adding new ones.
6988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006989 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006990 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6991
6992 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6993 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6994 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6995
6996 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6997 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006998 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006999
7000
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010070017. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7002------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007003
7004The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7005content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7006from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7007simple :
7008
7009 - define test criteria with sets of values
7010 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7011
7012The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7013
7014In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7015
7016 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7017
7018This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7019Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7020and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7021an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7022of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7023
7024ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7025'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7026which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7027
7028There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7029performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7030
7031The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7032
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007033 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7034 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007035 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7036
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007037The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7038specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7039possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007040multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7041be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7042needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7043space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7044match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7045lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7046duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7047to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7048instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007049
7050 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7051
7052In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7053the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7054case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7055too.
7056
7057Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7058a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7059ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007061Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007062
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007063 - integers or integer ranges
7064 - strings
7065 - regular expressions
7066 - IP addresses and networks
7067
7068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070697.1. Matching integers
7070----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007071
7072Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7073that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7074expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7075may be omitted.
7076
7077For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7078unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7079representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7080
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007081As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7082two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7083instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7084ranges and operators.
7085
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007086For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007087operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7088Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7089of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007091Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007092
7093 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7094 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7095 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7096 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7097 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7098
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007099For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007100
7101 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7102
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007103This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7104
7105 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071087.2. Matching strings
7109---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007110
7111String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7112exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7113characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7114string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7115to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007116before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007117
7118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071197.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7120-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007121
7122Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7123they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7124possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7125passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7126the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007127the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7128match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007129
7130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071317.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7132----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007133
7134IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7135netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7136within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007137host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007138difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7139at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7140does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7141parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007142
7143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071447.5. Available matching criteria
7145--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071477.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7148------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007149
7150A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7151analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7152addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007154always_false
7155 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7156 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7157
7158always_true
7159 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7160 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7161
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007162avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007163avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007164 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7165 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7166 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7167 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7168 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7169 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7170 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7171 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7172 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7173 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7174 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007175
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007176be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007177be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007178 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7179 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7180 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7181 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7182 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007183
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007184be_id <integer>
7185 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7186 backend it was called.
7187
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007188be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007189be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007190 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7191 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7192 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7193 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7194 sucking of an online dictionary).
7195
7196 Example :
7197 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7198 backend dynamic
7199 mode http
7200 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7201 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007202
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007203connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007204connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007205 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007206 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007207 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7208
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007209 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7210 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007211
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007212 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007213 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7214 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7215 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7216 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7217 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007218 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007219
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007220 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7221 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7222 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7223 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007224
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007225dst <ip_address>
7226 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7227 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007228
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007229dst_conn <integer>
7230 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7231 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7232 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7233 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7234 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7235 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7236
7237dst_port <integer>
7238 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7239 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7240
7241fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007242fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007243 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7244 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7245 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7246 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7247 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7248 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7249 criteria.
7250
7251fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007252 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007253 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007254
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007255fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007256fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007257 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7258 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7259 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7260 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7261 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7262 the rate to go down below the limit.
7263
7264 Example :
7265 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7266 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7267 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7268 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7269 frontend mail
7270 bind :25
7271 mode tcp
7272 maxconn 100
7273 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7274 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7275 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7276 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007277
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007278nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007279nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007280 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7281 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7282 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7283 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7284 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007285
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007286queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007287queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007288 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7289 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7290 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7291 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7292 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7293 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7294 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007296sc1_bytes_in_rate
7297sc2_bytes_in_rate
7298 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7299 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7300 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7301
7302sc1_bytes_out_rate
7303sc2_bytes_out_rate
7304 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7305 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7306 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7307
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007308sc1_clr_gpc0
7309sc2_clr_gpc0
7310 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7311 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7312 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7313 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7314 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7315 was verified :
7316
7317 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7318 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7319 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7320 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7321 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7322 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7323 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007325sc1_conn_cnt
7326sc2_conn_cnt
7327 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7328 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7329
7330sc1_conn_cur
7331sc2_conn_cur
7332 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7333 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7334 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7335
7336sc1_conn_rate
7337sc2_conn_rate
7338 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7339 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7340 See also src_conn_rate.
7341
7342sc1_get_gpc0
7343sc2_get_gpc0
7344 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7345 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7346
7347sc1_http_err_cnt
7348sc2_http_err_cnt
7349 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7350 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7351 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7352
7353sc1_http_err_rate
7354sc2_http_err_rate
7355 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7356 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7357 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7358 src_http_err_rate.
7359
7360sc1_http_req_cnt
7361sc2_http_req_cnt
7362 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7363 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7364 src_http_req_cnt.
7365
7366sc1_http_req_rate
7367sc2_http_req_rate
7368 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7369 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7370 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7371 src_http_req_rate.
7372
7373sc1_inc_gpc0
7374sc2_inc_gpc0
7375 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7376 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7377 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7378 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7379 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7380 when a first ACL was verified :
7381
7382 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7383 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7384 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7385
7386sc1_kbytes_in
7387sc2_kbytes_in
7388 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7389 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7390 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7391 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7392
7393sc1_kbytes_out
7394sc2_kbytes_out
7395 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7396 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7397 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7398 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7399
7400sc1_sess_cnt
7401sc2_sess_cnt
7402 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7403 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7404 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7405 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7406 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7407 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7408
7409sc1_sess_rate
7410sc2_sess_rate
7411 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7412 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7413 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7414 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7415 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7416 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7417
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007418so_id <integer>
7419 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7420
7421src <ip_address>
7422 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7423 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7424 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7425
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007426src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007427src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007428 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7429 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7430 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007431 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007432
7433src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007434src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007435 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7436 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7437 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007438 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007439
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007440src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7441src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7442 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7443 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7444 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7445 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7446 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7447 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7448
7449 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7450 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7451 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7452 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7453 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7454 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7455 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7456
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007457src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007458src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007459 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7460 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7461 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007462 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007463
7464src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007465src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007466 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7467 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7468 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007469 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007470
7471src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007472src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007473 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7474 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7475 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007476 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007477
7478src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007479src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007480 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7481 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7482 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007483 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007484
7485src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007486src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007487 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7488 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7489 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007490 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007491
7492src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007493src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007494 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7495 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7496 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7497 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007498 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007499
7500src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007501src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007502 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7503 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7504 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007505 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007506
7507src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007508src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007509 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7510 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7511 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7512 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007513 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007514
7515src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007516src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007517 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7518 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7519 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7520 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7521 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7522 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7523
7524 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7525 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007526 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007527
7528src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007529src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007530 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7531 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7532 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7533 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007534 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007535
7536src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007537src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007538 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7539 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7540 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7541 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007542 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007543
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007544src_port <integer>
7545 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007546
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007547src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007548src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007549 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7550 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7551 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7552 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007554
7555src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007556src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007557 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7558 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7559 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7560 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007561 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007562
7563src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007564src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007565 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007566 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7567 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007568 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7569 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7570 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007571 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007572
7573 Example :
7574 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7575 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7576 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7577 listen ssh
7578 bind :22
7579 mode tcp
7580 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007581 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007582 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7583 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7584
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007585srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007586 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7587 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7588 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7589 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7590
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007591srv_id <integer>
7592 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7593
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007594srv_is_up(<server>)
7595srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7596 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7597 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7598 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7599 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7600 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7601 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7602 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7603 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7604
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007605table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007606table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007607 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7608 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7609
7610table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007611table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007612 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7613 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7614 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7615
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007616
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020076177.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7618---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007619
7620A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7621during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007622through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7623keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007624
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007625rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7626 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7627 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7628 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7629 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7630
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007631req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007632 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007633 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7634 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7635 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7636 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7637 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7638 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7639
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007640req_proto_http
7641 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7642 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007643 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007644 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7645 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7646
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007647req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007648req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007649 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7650 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7651 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7652 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7653 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7654 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7655 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7656 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7657
7658req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007659req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007660 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7661 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7662 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7663 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7664 cookies.
7665
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007666req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7667 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7668 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7669 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7670 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7671
7672req_ssl_sni <string>
7673 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7674 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7675 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7676 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7677 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7678 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7679 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7680 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7681
7682 Examples :
7683 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7684 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7685 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7686 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7687 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7688
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007689req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7690 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7691 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7692 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7693 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7694 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7695 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7696 with TCP request content inspection.
7697
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007698wait_end
7699 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7700 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7701 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7702 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7703 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7704 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7705 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7706 inspection.
7707
7708 Examples :
7709 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7710 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7711 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7712
7713 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7714 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7715 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7716 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7717 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7718 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7719 tcp-request content reject
7720
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077227.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7723--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007724
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007725A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007726application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7727read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7728than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7729
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007730hdr <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007731hdr(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007732 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7733 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7734 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7735 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7736 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7737
7738 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7739 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7740 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7741
7742 hdr(Connection) -i close
7743
7744hdr_beg <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007745hdr_beg(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007746 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7747 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7748 response headers sent by the server.
7749
7750hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007751hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007752 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7753 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7754 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7755 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7756 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7757 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7758 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7759
7760hdr_dir <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007761hdr_dir(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007762 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7763 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7764 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7765 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7766 headers sent by the server.
7767
7768hdr_dom <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007769hdr_dom(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007770 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7771 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7772 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7773 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7774 server.
7775
7776hdr_end <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007777hdr_end(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007778 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7779 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7780 response headers sent by the server.
7781
7782hdr_ip <ip_address>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007783hdr_ip(<header>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007784 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7785 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7786 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7787 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7788
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007789hdr_len <integer>
7790hdr_len(<header>) <integer>
7791 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
7792 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7793 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7794 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7795
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007796hdr_reg <regex>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007797hdr_reg(<header>) <regex>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007798 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7799 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7800 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7801 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7802 response headers sent by the server.
7803
7804hdr_sub <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007805hdr_sub(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007806 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7807 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7808 response headers sent by the server.
7809
7810hdr_val <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007811hdr_val(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007812 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7813 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7814 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7815 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7816
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007817http_auth(<userlist>)
7818http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007819 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7820 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7821 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7822 of specified groups.
7823
7824 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7825
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02007826http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007827 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7828 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7829 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7830 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7831
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007832method <string>
7833 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7834 already check for most common methods.
7835
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007836path <string>
7837 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7838 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7839 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7840
7841path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007842 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7843 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007844
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007845path_dir <string>
7846 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7847 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7848 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7849 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7850
7851path_dom <string>
7852 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7853 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7854 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7855
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007856path_end <string>
7857 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7858 control file name extension.
7859
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007860path_len <integer>
7861 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
7862 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7863
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007864path_reg <regex>
7865 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7866 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7867 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7868
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007869path_sub <string>
7870 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7871 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7872 "path_dir".
7873
7874req_ver <string>
7875 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7876 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7877
7878status <integer>
7879 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7880 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7881 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7882
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007883url <string>
7884 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7885 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7886
7887url_beg <string>
7888 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7889 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7890
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007891url_dir <string>
7892 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7893 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7894 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7895 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7896
7897url_dom <string>
7898 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7899 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7900 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7901
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007902url_end <string>
7903 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7904 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007905
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007906url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007907 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7908 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007909 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007910
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007911url_len <integer>
7912 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
7913 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7914
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007915url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007916 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7917 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007918 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007919 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007920
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007921url_reg <regex>
7922 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7923 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7924 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007925
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007926url_sub <string>
7927 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7928 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007929
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079317.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7932---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007934Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7935every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007936order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007938ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7939---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007940FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007941HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007942HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7943HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007944HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7945HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7946HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7947HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7948LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007949METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7950METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7951METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7952METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7953METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7954METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007955RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007956REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007957TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007958WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7959---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007960
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079627.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7963----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007965Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7966combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007968 - AND (implicit)
7969 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7970 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007972A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007974 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007976Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7977indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007979For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7980"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7981requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7982is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007984 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7985 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7986 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7987 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007989To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7990and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007992 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7993 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7994 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7995 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007997 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7998 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7999 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8000 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008001
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008002It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8003expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8004be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8005the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8006
8007 The following rule :
8008
8009 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8010 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8011
8012 Can also be written that way :
8013
8014 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8015
8016It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8017to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8018simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8019sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8020good use is the following :
8021
8022 With named ACLs :
8023
8024 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8025 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8026 monitor fail if site_dead
8027
8028 With anonymous ACLs :
8029
8030 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008032See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008033
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008034
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010080357.8. Pattern extraction
8036-----------------------
8037
8038The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8039response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8040for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8041
8042All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8043"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8044begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8045arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8046much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8047equivalent used in ACLs.
8048
8049The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8050
8051 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008052 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8053 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8054 according to RFC 4291.
8055
8056 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
8057 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008058
8059 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8060 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8061 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008062 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8063 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8064 according to RFC 4291.
8065
8066 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
8067 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8068 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008069 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008070
8071 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8072 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8073 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8074 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8075 type integer and only works with such tables.
8076
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008077 hdr(<name>) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8078 request. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
8079 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008080
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008081 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008082 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8083 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8084 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8085 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008086
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008087 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008088 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8089 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8090 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8091 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8092 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8093 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8094 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8095 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
8096
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008097 url_param(<name>)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008098 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008099 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008100 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
8101 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8102 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
8103
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008104 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008105 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8106 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8107 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8108 done if there is no msts cookie present.
8109
8110 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8111 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8112 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8113 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8114 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8115 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8116 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
8117
8118 Example :
8119 listen tse-farm
8120 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8121 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8122 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8123 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8124 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8125 persist rdp-cookie
8126 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8127 # This is only useful makes sense if
8128 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8129 stick-table type string size 204800
8130 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8131 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8132 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
8133
8134 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8135 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
8136
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008137 cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008138 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8139 "Cookie" header line from the request and uses the corresponding
8140 value to match. A typical use is to get multiple clients sharing
8141 a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
8142 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with
8143 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across
8144 restarts.
8145
8146 See also : "appsession"
8147
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008148 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008149 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8150 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8151 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8152 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8153 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
8154
8155 See also : "appsession"
8156
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008157
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008158The currently available list of transformations include :
8159
8160 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8161 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8162 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8163
8164 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8165 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8166 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8167
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008168 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008169 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8170 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8171 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8172 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8173
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081758. Logging
8176----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008177
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008178One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8179provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8180very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8181provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8182state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008183to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008184headers.
8185
8186In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8187about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8188send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8189
8190 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8191 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8192 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8193 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8194 at the termination.
8195
8196The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8197allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8198as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8199while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8200real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8201delay.
8202
8203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082048.1. Log levels
8205---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008206
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008207TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008208source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008209HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8210in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8211track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8212syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8213about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008214
8215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082168.2. Log formats
8217----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008218
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008219HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008220and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8221slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8222options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008223
8224 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8225 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8226 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8227 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8228 extents.
8229
8230 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8231 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8232 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8233 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8234 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8235
8236 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8237 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8238 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8239 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8240 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8241
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008242 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8243 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8244 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8245 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8246
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008247Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8248specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8249field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8250servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8251always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8252identifier.
8253
8254Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8255 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8256 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8257 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8258 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8259
8260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082618.2.1. Default log format
8262-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008263
8264This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8265as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8266format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8267
8268 Example :
8269 listen www
8270 mode http
8271 log global
8272 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8273
8274 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8275 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8276 (www/HTTP)
8277
8278 Field Format Extract from the example above
8279 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8280 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8281 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8282 4 'to' to
8283 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8284 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8285
8286Detailed fields description :
8287 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8288 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8289 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8290 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8291 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8292 and processed the connection.
8293 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8294
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008295In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8296"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8297connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008299It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8300will eventually disappear.
8301
8302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083038.2.2. TCP log format
8304---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008305
8306The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8307is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8308information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8309counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8310emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8311environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8312the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8313sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008314specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8315not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8316fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8317marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008318
8319 Example :
8320 frontend fnt
8321 mode tcp
8322 option tcplog
8323 log global
8324 default_backend bck
8325
8326 backend bck
8327 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8328
8329 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8330 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8331 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8332
8333 Field Format Extract from the example above
8334 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8335 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8336 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8337 4 frontend_name fnt
8338 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8339 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8340 7 bytes_read* 212
8341 8 termination_state --
8342 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8343 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8344
8345Detailed fields description :
8346 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008347 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8348 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8349 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8350 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8351 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008352
8353 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008354 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8355 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8356 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008357
8358 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8359 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8360 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8361 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8362
8363 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8364 and processed the connection.
8365
8366 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8367 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8368 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8369 applications.
8370
8371 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8372 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8373 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8374 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8375 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8376
8377 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8378 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8379 See "Timers" below for more details.
8380
8381 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8382 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8383 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8384 "Timers" below for more details.
8385
8386 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8387 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8388 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8389 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8390 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8391 details.
8392
8393 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8394 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8395 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8396 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8397 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8398
8399 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8400 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8401 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8402 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8403 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8404 for more details.
8405
8406 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8407 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8408 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8409 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8410 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008411 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008412
8413 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8414 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8415 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8416 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8417 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8418 caused by a denial of service attack.
8419
8420 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8421 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8422 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8423 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8424 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8425 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8426 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8427 denial of service attack.
8428
8429 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8430 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8431 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8432 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8433 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8434 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8435 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8436 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8437 be processed than on other servers.
8438
8439 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8440 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8441 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8442 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8443 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8444 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8445 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8446 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8447 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8448 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8449 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8450 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8451 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8452
8453 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8454 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8455 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8456 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8457 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8458 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8459 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8460 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8461
8462 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8463 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8464 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8465 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8466 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8467 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8468 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8469 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8470 occurs.
8471
8472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084738.2.3. HTTP log format
8474----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008475
8476The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8477is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8478the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8479are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8480emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8481generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8482"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8483which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008484frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8485is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008486
8487Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8488slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8489with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8490
8491 Example :
8492 frontend http-in
8493 mode http
8494 option httplog
8495 log global
8496 default_backend bck
8497
8498 backend static
8499 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8500
8501 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8502 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8503 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008504 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008505
8506 Field Format Extract from the example above
8507 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8508 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8509 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8510 4 frontend_name http-in
8511 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8512 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8513 7 status_code 200
8514 8 bytes_read* 2750
8515 9 captured_request_cookie -
8516 10 captured_response_cookie -
8517 11 termination_state ----
8518 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8519 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8520 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8521 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8522 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008523
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008524
8525Detailed fields description :
8526 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008527 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8528 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8529 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8530 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8531 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008532
8533 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008534 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8535 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8536 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008537
8538 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8539 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8540 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8541 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8542 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8543
8544 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8545 and processed the connection.
8546
8547 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8548 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8549 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8550
8551 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8552 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8553 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8554 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8555 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8556 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8557
8558 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8559 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8560 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8561 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8562 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8563 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8564
8565 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8566 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8567 See "Timers" below for more details.
8568
8569 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8570 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8571 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8572 below for more details.
8573
8574 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8575 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8576 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8577 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8578 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8579 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8580 for more details.
8581
8582 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8583 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8584 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8585 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8586 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8587 details.
8588
8589 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8590 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8591 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8592
8593 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8594 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8595 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8596 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8597 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8598 overflowing.
8599
8600 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8601 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8602 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8603 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8604 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8605 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8606 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8607 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8608
8609 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8610 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8611 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8612 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8613 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8614 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8615 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8616 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8617
8618 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8619 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8620 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8621 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8622 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8623 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8624 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8625
8626 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8627 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8628 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8629 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8630 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008631 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008632 system.
8633
8634 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8635 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8636 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8637 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8638 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8639 caused by a denial of service attack.
8640
8641 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8642 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8643 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8644 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8645 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8646 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8647 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8648 denial of service attack.
8649
8650 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8651 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8652 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8653 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8654 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8655 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8656 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8657 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8658 processed than on other servers.
8659
8660 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8661 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8662 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8663 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8664 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8665 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8666 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8667 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8668 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8669 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8670 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8671 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8672 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8673
8674 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8675 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8676 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8677 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8678 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8679 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8680 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8681 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8682
8683 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8684 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8685 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8686 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8687 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8688 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8689 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8690 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8691 occurs.
8692
8693 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8694 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8695 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8696 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8697 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8698 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8699 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8700 cookies" below for more details.
8701
8702 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8703 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8704 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8705 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8706 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8707 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8708 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8709 and cookies" below for more details.
8710
8711 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8712 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8713 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8714 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8715 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8716 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8717 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8718 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8719
8720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087218.3. Advanced logging options
8722-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008723
8724Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8725just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8726options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8727for more information about their usage.
8728
8729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087308.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8731------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008732
8733It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8734haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8735commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8736monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8737ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8738
8739 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8740 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8741 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8742 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8743
8744 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8745 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8746 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8747 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8748 such as other load-balancers.
8749
8750 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8751 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8752 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8753
8754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087558.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8756----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008757
8758The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8759what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8760or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8761"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8762just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8763log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8764after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8765is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8766with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8767with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8768
8769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087708.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8771------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008772
8773Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8774for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8775"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8776retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8777raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8778a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8779file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8780you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8781"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8782
8783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8785--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008786
8787Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8788multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8789them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8790"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8791logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8792error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8793and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8794too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8795useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8796alternative.
8797
8798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087998.4. Timing events
8800------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008801
8802Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8803reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8804the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8805frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8806mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8807
8808 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8809 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8810 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8811 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8812 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8813
8814 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8815 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8816 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8817 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8818 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8819
8820 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8821 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8822 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8823 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8824 connection never established.
8825
8826 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8827 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8828 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8829 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8830 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8831 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8832 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8833 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8834 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8835 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8836 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8837
8838 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8839 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8840 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8841 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8842 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8843
8844 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8845
8846 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8847 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8848 negative.
8849
8850These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8851protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8852that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008853due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008854close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8855session has been aborted on timeout.
8856
8857Most common cases :
8858
8859 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8860 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8861 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8862 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8863 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8864 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8865 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8866 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8867 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008868 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8869 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8870 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008871
8872 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8873 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8874 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8875 of ms on remote networks.
8876
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008877 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8878 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8879 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008880
8881 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8882 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8883 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8884 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8885 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8886 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8887 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8888 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8889 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8890 to the server until another one is released.
8891
8892Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8893
8894 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8895 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8896 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8897
8898 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8899 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8900 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8901
8902 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8903 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8904 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8905 flags.
8906
8907 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8908 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8909 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8910 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8911 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8912 the client connection was maintained open.
8913
8914 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8915 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8916 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8917 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8918
8919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089208.5. Session state at disconnection
8921-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008922
8923TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8924"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
89252-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8926each of which has a special meaning :
8927
8928 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8929 session to terminate :
8930
8931 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8932
8933 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8934 server explicitly refused it.
8935
8936 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8937 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8938 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8939 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8940 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8941 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8942
8943 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8944 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8945 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8946 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8947 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8948
8949 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8950 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8951 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8952 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8953 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8954
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09008955 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
8956 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
8957
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02008958 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
8959
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008960 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8961 send or receive data.
8962
8963 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8964 send or receive data.
8965
8966 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8967 with nothing left in the buffers.
8968
8969 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8970
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008971 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008972 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8973
8974 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8975 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8976 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8977 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8978 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8979
8980 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8981 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8982
8983 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8984 server (HTTP only).
8985
8986 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8987
8988 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8989 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8990 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8991
8992 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8993 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8994 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8995
8996 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8997
8998 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8999 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9000
9001 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9002 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9003 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9004
9005 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9006 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009007 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9008 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009009
9010 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9011 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9012 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9013 another server.
9014
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009015 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009016 server.
9017
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009018 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9019 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9020 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9021 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9022
9023 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9024 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9025 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9026 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9027
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009028 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9029
9030 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9031 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9032
9033 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9034
9035 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9036 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9037 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9038
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009039 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9040 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9041 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9042 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9043 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9044
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009045 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9046
9047 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9048 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9049
9050 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9051
9052 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9053
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009054The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9055was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009056helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9057starvation, attacks, etc...
9058
9059The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9060alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9061easier finding and understanding.
9062
9063 Flags Reason
9064
9065 -- Normal termination.
9066
9067 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9068 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9069 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9070 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9071
9072 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9073 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9074 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9075 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9076 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9077 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009078
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009079 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9080 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
9081 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
9082
9083 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9084 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9085 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9086
9087 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9088 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9089 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9090 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9091 the server takes too long to respond.
9092
9093 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9094 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9095 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9096 long a time to respond.
9097
9098 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9099 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9100 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9101 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9102 and the client.
9103
9104 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9105 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9106 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9107 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9108 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9109 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9110
9111 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9112 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009113 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9114 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9115 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9116 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009118 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009119 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9120 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9121 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9122 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9123 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9124
9125 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9126 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9127 503 or 504 here.
9128
9129 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9130 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9131 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9132 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9133 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9134
9135 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9136 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009137 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009138 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9139 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9140
9141 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9142 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9143 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9144 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9145 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9146 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9147 between haproxy and the server.
9148
9149 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9150 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9151 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9152 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9153 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9154 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9155 solution is to fix the application.
9156
9157 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9158 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9159 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9160 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9161 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9162 external attacks.
9163
9164 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9165 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
9166 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
9167 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9168 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9169
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009170 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9171 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9172 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9173 the client.
9174
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009175 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9176 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9177 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9178 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009179 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9180 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9181 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9182 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9183 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009184
9185 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9186 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9187 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9188 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9189
9190 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9191 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9192 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9193 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9194
9195 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9196 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9197 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9198 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9199
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009200The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9201persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9202important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9203re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9204
9205 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9206
9207 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9208 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9209 set on a GET request.
9210
9211 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9212 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9213 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9214 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9215
9216 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9217 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9218 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9219
9220 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9221 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9222 already got a cookie.
9223
9224 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9225 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9226 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9227 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9228 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9229
9230 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9231 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9232 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9233
9234 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9235 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9236 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9237
9238 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9239 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9240
9241 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9242 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9243 then advertised in the response.
9244
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092468.6. Non-printable characters
9247-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009248
9249In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9250consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9251converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9252prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9253being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9254escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9255is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9256'}' when logging headers.
9257
9258Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9259issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9260containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9261
9262Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9263the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9264performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9265
9266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092678.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9268---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009269
9270Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9271achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009272section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009273cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9274the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9275the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009276locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009277not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9278user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9279a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9280wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9281
9282 Examples :
9283 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9284 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9285
9286 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9287 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9288
9289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092908.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9291---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009292
9293Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9294proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9295the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9296server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9297
9298Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9299response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009300section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009301
9302It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009303time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9304appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009305are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9306and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9307follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9308request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9309in the logs.
9310
9311 Example :
9312 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9313 listen proxy-out
9314 mode http
9315 option httplog
9316 option logasap
9317 log global
9318 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9319
9320 # log the name of the virtual server
9321 capture request header Host len 20
9322
9323 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9324 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9325
9326 # log the beginning of the referrer
9327 capture request header Referer len 20
9328
9329 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9330 capture response header Server len 20
9331
9332 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9333 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9334
9335 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9336 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9337
9338 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9339 capture response header Via len 20
9340
9341 # log the URL location during a redirection
9342 capture response header Location len 20
9343
9344 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9345 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9346 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9347 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9348 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9349
9350 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9351 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9352 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9353 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009354 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009355
9356 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9357 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9358 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9359 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9360 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009361 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009362
9363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093648.9. Examples of logs
9365---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009366
9367These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9368them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9369reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9370
9371 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9372 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9373 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9374
9375 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9376 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9377
9378 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9379 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9380 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9381
9382 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9383 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9384
9385 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9386 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9387 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9388
9389 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009390 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009391 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9392 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9393
9394 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9395 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9396 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9397
9398 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9399 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009400 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009401 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9402 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9403 to return the 502 and not the server.
9404
9405 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009406 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009407
9408 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9409 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9410 Nothing was sent to any server.
9411
9412 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9413 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9414
9415 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9416 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9417 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9418 send a 408 return code to the client.
9419
9420 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9421 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9422
9423 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9424 5 seconds ("c----").
9425
9426 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9427 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009428 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009429
9430 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009431 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009432 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9433 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9434 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9435 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9436 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009437
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094399. Statistics and monitoring
9440----------------------------
9441
9442It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9443mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9444CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9445Unix socket.
9446
9447
94489.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009449---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009450
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009451The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9452page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009454 0. pxname: proxy name
9455 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9456 for server)
9457 2. qcur: current queued requests
9458 3. qmax: max queued requests
9459 4. scur: current sessions
9460 5. smax: max sessions
9461 6. slim: sessions limit
9462 7. stot: total sessions
9463 8. bin: bytes in
9464 9. bout: bytes out
9465 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009466 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009467 12. ereq: request errors
9468 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009469 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009470 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9471 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009472 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009473 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9474 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9475 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9476 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9477 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9478 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9479 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9480 25. qlimit: queue limit
9481 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9482 27. iid: unique proxy id
9483 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9484 29. throttle: warm up status
9485 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9486 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009487 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009488 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9489 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9490 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009491 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009492 UNK -> unknown
9493 INI -> initializing
9494 SOCKERR -> socket error
9495 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9496 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9497 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9498 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9499 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9500 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9501 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9502 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9503 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9504 disable-on-404
9505 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9506 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9507 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009508 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9509 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009510 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9511 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9512 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9513 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9514 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9515 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009516 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9517 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9518 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9519 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009520 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9521 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009522
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095249.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009525-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009526
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009527The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009528must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9529is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9530a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9531risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9532followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9533given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9534then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9535to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009536
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009537It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9538on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9539own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009541clear counters
9542 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9543 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9544 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9545 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9546 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9547
9548clear counters all
9549 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9550 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9551 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9552
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009553clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9554 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9555
9556 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9557 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9558 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9559 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9560 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9561 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9562
9563 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9564
9565 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9566 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9567 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9568 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9569 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9570 the ACLs :
9571
9572 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9573 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9574 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9575 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9576 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9577 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9578
9579 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009580 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9581 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009582
9583 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009584 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009585 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009586 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9587 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9588 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9589 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009590
9591 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9592
9593 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009594 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009595 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9596 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009597 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9598 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9599 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009600
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009601disable frontend <frontend>
9602 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
9603 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
9604 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
9605 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
9606 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
9607 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
9608 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
9609 on the stats page.
9610
9611 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9612 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9613
9614 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9615 level "admin".
9616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009617disable server <backend>/<server>
9618 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9619 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9620 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9621 during the maintenance.
9622
9623 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9624 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9625
9626 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009627 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009628
9629 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9630 level "admin".
9631
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009632enable frontend <frontend>
9633 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
9634 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
9635 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
9636 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
9637 which was disabled.
9638
9639 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9640 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9641
9642 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9643 level "admin".
9644
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009645enable server <backend>/<server>
9646 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9647 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9648
9649 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009650 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009651
9652 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9653 level "admin".
9654
9655get weight <backend>/<server>
9656 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9657 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9658 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9659 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9660 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009661 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009662
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009663help
9664 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9665 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009666
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009667prompt
9668 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9669 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9670 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9671 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9672 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9673 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9674 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9675 command.
9676
9677quit
9678 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009679
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +02009680set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
9681 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
9682 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
9683 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
9684 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9685 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9686 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
9687 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9688
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +02009689set maxconn global <maxconn>
9690 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
9691 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
9692 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9693 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9694 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
9695 setting.
9696
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +02009697set rate-limit connections global <value>
9698 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
9699 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
9700 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
9701 is passed in number of connections per second.
9702
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009703set timeout cli <delay>
9704 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9705 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9706 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9707
9708set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9709 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9710 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9711 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9712 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9713 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9714 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9715 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9716 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9717 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9718 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9719 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9720 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9721 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009722 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009723
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009724show errors [<iid>]
9725 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9726 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009727 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9728 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9729 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009730
9731 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9732 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9733 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9734 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9735 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9736 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9737 are reported too.
9738
9739 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9740 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9741 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9742 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9743 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9744 code.
9745
9746 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9747 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9748 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9749 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9750 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9751 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9752 line.
9753
9754 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009755 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9756 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009757 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9758 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9759
9760 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9761 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9762 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9763 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9764 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9765 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9766 00204+ minal\r\n
9767 00211 \r\n
9768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009769 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009770 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9771 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9772 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9773 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9774 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9775 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009776
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009777show info
9778 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9779
9780show sess
9781 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009782 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9783 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9784
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009785show sess <id>
9786 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9787 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9788 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9789 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9790 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9791 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009792
9793show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9794 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9795 possible to dump only selected items :
9796 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9797 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9798 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9799 for example:
9800 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9801 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9802 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9803
9804 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009805 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9806 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009807 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9808 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9809 Nbproc: 1
9810 Process_num: 1
9811 (...)
9812
9813 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9814 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9815 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9816 (...)
9817 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9818
9819 $
9820
9821 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9822 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9823 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9824 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009825 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009826
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009827show table
9828 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9829 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9830 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9831 entries currently in use.
9832
9833 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009834 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009835 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
9836 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009837
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009838show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009839 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9840 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9841 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009842 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
9843
9844 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
9845 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
9846 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
9847 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
9848 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9849
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009850 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9851 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9852 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9853 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9854 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9855 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9856
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009857
9858 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009859 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
9860 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009861
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009862 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009863 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009864 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009865 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9866 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9867 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9868 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009869
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009870 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009871 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009872 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9873 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009874
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009875 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9876 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009877 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009878 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9879 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009880
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009881 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
9882 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009883 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009884 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9885 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
9886
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009887 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9888 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9889 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9890 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9891 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9892
9893 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9894 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9895 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009896 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9897 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009898 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9899 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009900
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009901shutdown frontend <frontend>
9902 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
9903 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
9904 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
9905 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
9906 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
9907 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
9908 once it is terminated.
9909
9910 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9911 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9912
9913 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9914 level "admin".
9915
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +02009916shutdown session <id>
9917 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
9918 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9919 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
9920 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
9921 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
9922 flag in the logs.
9923
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +02009924shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
9925 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
9926 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
9927 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
9928 'K' flag in the logs.
9929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009930/*
9931 * Local variables:
9932 * fill-column: 79
9933 * End:
9934 */